1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2    Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3    2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4    Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5    Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6    Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 
8 This file is part of GCC.
9 
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14 
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19 
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA.  */
24 
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 	   the file numbers are used by .debug_info.  Alternately, leave
27 	   out locations for types and decls.
28 	 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 	 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs.  */
30 
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32    information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33    mechanism.  The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34    DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35    information.  */
36 
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
70 
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
74 
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76    CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 	   a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 	   We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 	   The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 	   of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81    CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 	   an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83    CIE = Common Information Entry
84 	   information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85    DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86    FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 	   information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 	   how to restore registers
89 
90    DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91    DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
92 
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 #  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96   (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 #  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
101 
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103    collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104    .debug_frame and .eh_frame.  */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
108 
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110    translation unit.  */
111 
112 int
dwarf2out_do_frame(void)113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
114 {
115   /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116      have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117      we're not going to output frame or unwind info.  */
118   return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 	  || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 	  || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 	  || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 	      && (flag_unwind_tables
124 		  || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
126 	  );
127 }
128 
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type.  */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
133 
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135    must be kept around forever.  */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
137 
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139    completed at some later time.  incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140    VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141    it.  */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
143 
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145    scopes.  This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146    of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147    scopes.  This table is used to find the proper place to
148    define type declaration DIE's.  */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
150 
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections.  */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163 
164 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
165 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
166 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
167 #endif
168 
169 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
170 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
171 typedef union  dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172 
173 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
174    Information instructions.  The register number, offset
175    and address fields are provided as possible operands;
176    their use is selected by the opcode field.  */
177 
178 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
179   dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
180   dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
181   dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
182   dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
183   dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
184 };
185 
186 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 {
188   unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
189   HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
190   const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
191   struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 }
193 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194 
195 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 {
197   dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
198   enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
199   dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
200     dw_cfi_oprnd1;
201   dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
202     dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 }
204 dw_cfi_node;
205 
206 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
207    as REG + OFFSET all the time,  but now it can be more complex.
208    It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
209    Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
210    of this structure.  */
211 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 {
213   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
214   HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
215   unsigned int reg;
216   int indirect;            /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference.  */
217 } dw_cfa_location;
218 
219 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
220    refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
221    the beginning of the .debug_frame section.  This use of a single
222    CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
223    in the DWARF generation routines below.  */
224 
225 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 {
227   tree decl;
228   const char *dw_fde_begin;
229   const char *dw_fde_current_label;
230   const char *dw_fde_end;
231   const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
232   const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
233   const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
234   const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
235   bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
236   dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
237   unsigned funcdef_number;
238   unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
239   unsigned nothrow : 1;
240   unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 }
242 dw_fde_node;
243 
244 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label.  */
245 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES	30
246 
247 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
248    Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
249    but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses.  On such machines,
250    Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
251    pointers.  */
252 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
253 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
254 #endif
255 
256 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
257    relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
258    DWARF-2 specification.  The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
259    as PTR_SIZE.  */
260 
261 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
262 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
263 #endif
264 
265 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
266    should either be 4 or 12 bytes.  When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
267    bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
268    bytes.
269 
270    However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
271    DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE.  It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly.  */
272 
273 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
274 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
275 #endif
276 
277 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278 
279 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY.  */
280 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
281   ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282 
283 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor.  */
284 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
285 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
286 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
287 #else
288 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
289 #endif
290 #endif
291 
292 /* CIE identifier.  */
293 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
294 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
295   (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
296 #else
297 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
298 #endif
299 
300 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
301    information for each routine.  */
302 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
303 
304 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table.  */
305 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
306 
307 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use.  */
308 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
309 
310 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
311    fde_table.  */
312 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
313 
314 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE.  */
315 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
316 
317 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
318 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
319    attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
320    with the subprogram.  This variable holds the table index of the FDE
321    associated with the current function (body) definition.  */
322 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
323 #endif
324 
325 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
326 {
327   const char *str;
328   unsigned int refcount;
329   unsigned int form;
330   char *label;
331 };
332 
333 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
334 
335 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
336 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
337 
338 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
339 
340 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
341 
342 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
343 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
344 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
345 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
346 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
347 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
348 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
349 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
350 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
351 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
352 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
353 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
354 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
355 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
356 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
357 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
358 
359 /* Support for complex CFA locations.  */
360 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
361 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
362 				    struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
363 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
364   (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
365 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
366 
367 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
368 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
369 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
370 #endif
371 
372 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data.  */
373 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
374 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
375 
376 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
377 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION	".debug_frame"
378 #endif
379 
380 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
381 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL	"LFB"
382 #endif
383 
384 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
385 #define FUNC_END_LABEL		"LFE"
386 #endif
387 
388 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
389 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL	"Lframe"
390 #endif
391 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LSCIE"
392 #define CIE_END_LABEL		"LECIE"
393 #define FDE_LABEL		"LSFDE"
394 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LASFDE"
395 #define FDE_END_LABEL		"LEFDE"
396 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL	"LSLT"
397 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL	"LELT"
398 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL	"LASLTP"
399 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL	"LELTP"
400 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX	"DW"
401 
402 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address.  Normally this
403    is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
404    registers.  */
405 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
406 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
407 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
408 #else
409 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
410 #endif
411 #endif
412 
413 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number.  By
414    default, we just provide columns for all registers.  */
415 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
416 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
417 #endif
418 
419 /* Hook used by __throw.  */
420 
421 rtx
expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column(void)422 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
423 {
424   unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
425   return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
426 }
427 
428 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
429    attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name).  */
430 
431 static inline char *
stripattributes(const char * s)432 stripattributes (const char *s)
433 {
434   char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
435   char *p = stripped;
436 
437   *p++ = '*';
438 
439   while (*s && *s != ',')
440     *p++ = *s++;
441 
442   *p = '\0';
443   return stripped;
444 }
445 
446 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table.  */
447 
448 void
expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes(tree address)449 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
450 {
451   unsigned int i;
452   enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
453   rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
454   rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
455   bool wrote_return_column = false;
456 
457   for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
458     {
459       int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
460 
461       if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
462 	{
463 	  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
464 	  enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
465 	  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
466 
467 	  if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
468 	    save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
469 	  if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
470 	    {
471 	      if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
472 		continue;
473 	      wrote_return_column = true;
474 	    }
475 	  size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
476 	  if (offset < 0)
477 	    continue;
478 
479 	  emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
480 			  gen_int_mode (size, mode));
481 	}
482     }
483 
484 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
485   gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
486   i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
487   wrote_return_column = false;
488 #else
489   i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
490 #endif
491 
492   if (! wrote_return_column)
493     {
494       enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
495       HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
496       HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
497       emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
498     }
499 }
500 
501 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
502 
503 static const char *
dwarf_cfi_name(unsigned int cfi_opc)504 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
505 {
506   switch (cfi_opc)
507     {
508     case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
509       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
510     case DW_CFA_offset:
511       return "DW_CFA_offset";
512     case DW_CFA_restore:
513       return "DW_CFA_restore";
514     case DW_CFA_nop:
515       return "DW_CFA_nop";
516     case DW_CFA_set_loc:
517       return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
518     case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
519       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
520     case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
521       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
522     case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
523       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
524     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
525       return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
526     case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
527       return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
528     case DW_CFA_undefined:
529       return "DW_CFA_undefined";
530     case DW_CFA_same_value:
531       return "DW_CFA_same_value";
532     case DW_CFA_register:
533       return "DW_CFA_register";
534     case DW_CFA_remember_state:
535       return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
536     case DW_CFA_restore_state:
537       return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
538     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
539       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
540     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
541       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
542     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
543       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
544 
545     /* DWARF 3 */
546     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
547       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
548     case DW_CFA_expression:
549       return "DW_CFA_expression";
550     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
551       return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
552     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
553       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
554     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
555       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
556 
557     /* SGI/MIPS specific */
558     case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
559       return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
560 
561     /* GNU extensions */
562     case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
563       return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
564     case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
565       return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
566     case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
567       return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
568 
569     default:
570       return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
571     }
572 }
573 
574 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction.  */
575 
576 static inline dw_cfi_ref
new_cfi(void)577 new_cfi (void)
578 {
579   dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
580 
581   cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
582   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
583   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
584 
585   return cfi;
586 }
587 
588 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions.  */
589 
590 static inline void
add_cfi(dw_cfi_ref * list_head,dw_cfi_ref cfi)591 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
592 {
593   dw_cfi_ref *p;
594 
595   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
596   for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
597     ;
598 
599   *p = cfi;
600 }
601 
602 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to.  */
603 
604 char *
dwarf2out_cfi_label(void)605 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
606 {
607   static char label[20];
608 
609   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
610   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
611   return label;
612 }
613 
614 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
615    or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL.  */
616 
617 static void
add_fde_cfi(const char * label,dw_cfi_ref cfi)618 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
619 {
620   if (label)
621     {
622       dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
623 
624       if (*label == 0)
625 	label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
626 
627       if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
628 	  || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
629 	{
630 	  dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
631 
632 	  label = xstrdup (label);
633 
634 	  /* Set the location counter to the new label.  */
635 	  xcfi = new_cfi ();
636 	  /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
637 	     set the location directly using set_loc.  */
638 	  xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
639 			     ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
640 			     : DW_CFA_set_loc;
641 	  xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
642 	  add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
643 
644 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
645 	}
646 
647       add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
648     }
649 
650   else
651     add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
652 }
653 
654 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa.  */
655 
656 static void
lookup_cfa_1(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_cfa_location * loc)657 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
658 {
659   switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
660     {
661     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
662       loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
663       break;
664     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
665       loc->offset
666 	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
667       break;
668     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
669       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
670       break;
671     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
672       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
673       loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
674       break;
675     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
676       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
677       loc->offset
678 	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
679       break;
680     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
681       get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
682       break;
683     default:
684       break;
685     }
686 }
687 
688 /* Find the previous value for the CFA.  */
689 
690 static void
lookup_cfa(dw_cfa_location * loc)691 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
692 {
693   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
694 
695   loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
696   loc->offset = 0;
697   loc->indirect = 0;
698   loc->base_offset = 0;
699 
700   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
701     lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
702 
703   if (fde_table_in_use)
704     {
705       dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
706       for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
707 	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
708     }
709 }
710 
711 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address.  */
712 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
713 
714 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
715    from the CFA.  */
716 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
717 
718 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack.  */
719 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
720 
721 /* The last args_size we actually output.  */
722 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
723 
724 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
725    LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.  The value of CFA is now to be
726    calculated from REG+OFFSET.  */
727 
728 void
dwarf2out_def_cfa(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)729 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
730 {
731   dw_cfa_location loc;
732   loc.indirect = 0;
733   loc.base_offset = 0;
734   loc.reg = reg;
735   loc.offset = offset;
736   def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
737 }
738 
739 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data.  */
740 
741 static bool
cfa_equal_p(const dw_cfa_location * loc1,const dw_cfa_location * loc2)742 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
743 {
744   return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
745 	  && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
746 	  && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
747 	  && (loc1->indirect == 0
748 	      || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
749 }
750 
751 /* This routine does the actual work.  The CFA is now calculated from
752    the dw_cfa_location structure.  */
753 
754 static void
def_cfa_1(const char * label,dw_cfa_location * loc_p)755 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
756 {
757   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
758   dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
759 
760   cfa = *loc_p;
761   loc = *loc_p;
762 
763   if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
764     cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
765 
766   loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
767   lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
768 
769   /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions.  */
770   if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
771     return;
772 
773   cfi = new_cfi ();
774 
775   if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
776     {
777       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
778 	 the CFA register did not change but the offset did.  */
779       if (loc.offset < 0)
780 	{
781 	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
782 	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
783 
784 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
785 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
786 	}
787       else
788 	{
789 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
790 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
791 	}
792     }
793 
794 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO  /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset.  */
795   else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
796 	   && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
797 	   && !loc.indirect)
798     {
799       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
800 	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
801 	 offset has not changed.  */
802       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
803       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
804     }
805 #endif
806 
807   else if (loc.indirect == 0)
808     {
809       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
810 	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
811 	 the specified offset.  */
812       if (loc.offset < 0)
813 	{
814 	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
815 	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
816 
817 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
818 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
819 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
820 	}
821       else
822 	{
823 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
824 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
825 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
826 	}
827     }
828   else
829     {
830       /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
831 	 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
832 	 register-offset pair is available.  */
833       struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
834 
835       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
836       loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
837       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
838     }
839 
840   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
841 }
842 
843 /* Add the CFI for saving a register.  REG is the CFA column number.
844    LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
845    If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
846    otherwise it is saved in SREG.  */
847 
848 static void
reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,unsigned int sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)849 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
850 {
851   dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
852 
853   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
854 
855   if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
856     {
857       if (reg & ~0x3f)
858 	/* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
859 	   the long form.  */
860 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
861       else
862 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
863 
864 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
865       {
866 	/* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
867 	   DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
868 	   definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
869 	   description.  */
870 	HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
871 
872 	gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
873       }
874 #endif
875       offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
876       if (offset < 0)
877 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
878 
879       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
880     }
881   else if (sreg == reg)
882     cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
883   else
884     {
885       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
886       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
887     }
888 
889   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
890 }
891 
892 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window.  LABEL is passed to reg_save.
893    This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
894    from the previous frame's window save area.
895 
896    ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
897    assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window.  */
898 
899 void
dwarf2out_window_save(const char * label)900 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
901 {
902   dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
903 
904   cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
905   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
906 }
907 
908 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
909    pushed onto the stack.  */
910 
911 void
dwarf2out_args_size(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT size)912 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
913 {
914   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
915 
916   if (size == old_args_size)
917     return;
918 
919   old_args_size = size;
920 
921   cfi = new_cfi ();
922   cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
923   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
924   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
925 }
926 
927 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack.  REG is the GCC register
928    number.  LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
929 
930 void
dwarf2out_reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)931 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
932 {
933   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
934 }
935 
936 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
937    LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
938 
939 void
dwarf2out_return_save(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)940 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
941 {
942   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
943 }
944 
945 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
946    LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save.  */
947 
948 void
dwarf2out_return_reg(const char * label,unsigned int sreg)949 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
950 {
951   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
952 }
953 
954 /* Record the initial position of the return address.  RTL is
955    INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX.  */
956 
957 static void
initial_return_save(rtx rtl)958 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
959 {
960   unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
961   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
962 
963   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
964     {
965     case REG:
966       /* RA is in a register.  */
967       reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
968       break;
969 
970     case MEM:
971       /* RA is on the stack.  */
972       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
973       switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
974 	{
975 	case REG:
976 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
977 	  offset = 0;
978 	  break;
979 
980 	case PLUS:
981 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
982 	  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
983 	  break;
984 
985 	case MINUS:
986 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
987 	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
988 	  break;
989 
990 	default:
991 	  gcc_unreachable ();
992 	}
993 
994       break;
995 
996     case PLUS:
997       /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
998 	 actually load.  For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
999 	 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames.  */
1000       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1001       initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1002       return;
1003 
1004     default:
1005       gcc_unreachable ();
1006     }
1007 
1008   if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1009     reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1010 }
1011 
1012 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1013    contains.  */
1014 
1015 static HOST_WIDE_INT
stack_adjust_offset(rtx pattern)1016 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1017 {
1018   rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1019   rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1020   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1021   enum rtx_code code;
1022 
1023   if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1024     {
1025       /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1026       code = GET_CODE (src);
1027       if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1028 	  || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1029 	  || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1030 	return 0;
1031 
1032       offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1033       if (code == PLUS)
1034 	offset = -offset;
1035     }
1036   else if (MEM_P (dest))
1037     {
1038       /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1039       src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1040       code = GET_CODE (src);
1041 
1042       switch (code)
1043 	{
1044 	case PRE_MODIFY:
1045 	case POST_MODIFY:
1046 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1047 	    {
1048 	      rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1049 	      /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount.  */
1050 	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1051 			  && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1052 	      offset = -INTVAL (val);
1053 	      break;
1054 	    }
1055 	  return 0;
1056 
1057 	case PRE_DEC:
1058 	case POST_DEC:
1059 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1060 	    {
1061 	      offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1062 	      break;
1063 	    }
1064 	  return 0;
1065 
1066 	case PRE_INC:
1067 	case POST_INC:
1068 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1069 	    {
1070 	      offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1071 	      break;
1072 	    }
1073 	  return 0;
1074 
1075 	default:
1076 	  return 0;
1077 	}
1078     }
1079   else
1080     return 0;
1081 
1082   return offset;
1083 }
1084 
1085 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1086    make a note of it if it does.  EH uses this information to find out how
1087    much extra space it needs to pop off the stack.  */
1088 
1089 static void
dwarf2out_stack_adjust(rtx insn,bool after_p)1090 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1091 {
1092   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1093   const char *label;
1094   int i;
1095 
1096   /* Don't handle epilogues at all.  Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1097      with this function.  Proper support would require all frame-related
1098      insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1099      epilogues textually in the middle of the function.  */
1100   if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1101     return;
1102 
1103   /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1104      save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN.  */
1105   if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1106     {
1107       if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1108 	{
1109 	  /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself.  */
1110 	  insn = PATTERN (insn);
1111 	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1112 	    insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1113 	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1114 	    insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1115 	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1116 	  dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1117 	}
1118       return;
1119     }
1120 
1121   if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1122     {
1123       if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1124 	dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1125       return;
1126     }
1127   else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1128     {
1129       /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0.  Usually
1130 	 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1131 	 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions.  */
1132 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1133       offset = -args_size;
1134 #else
1135       offset = args_size;
1136 #endif
1137     }
1138   else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1139     offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1140   else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1141 	   || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1142     {
1143       /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns.  Search
1144 	 for them.  */
1145       for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1146 	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1147 	  offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1148     }
1149   else
1150     return;
1151 
1152   if (offset == 0)
1153     return;
1154 
1155   if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1156     cfa.offset += offset;
1157 
1158 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1159   offset = -offset;
1160 #endif
1161 
1162   args_size += offset;
1163   if (args_size < 0)
1164     args_size = 0;
1165 
1166   label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1167   def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1168   if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1169     dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1170 }
1171 
1172 #endif
1173 
1174 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1175    of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered.  This clusters
1176    register saves so that there are fewer pc advances.  */
1177 
1178 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1179 {
1180   struct queued_reg_save *next;
1181   rtx reg;
1182   HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1183   rtx saved_reg;
1184 };
1185 
1186 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1187 
1188 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG.  */
1189 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1190   rtx orig_reg;
1191   rtx saved_in_reg;
1192 };
1193 
1194 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1195    The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1196    port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1197    more efficient data structure.  */
1198 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1199 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1200 
1201 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1202 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1203 
1204 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1205    SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA.  */
1206 
1207 static void
queue_reg_save(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)1208 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1209 {
1210   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1211 
1212   /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1213      for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1214      order.  */
1215   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1216     if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1217       break;
1218 
1219   if (q == NULL)
1220     {
1221       q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1222       q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1223       queued_reg_saves = q;
1224     }
1225 
1226   q->reg = reg;
1227   q->cfa_offset = offset;
1228   q->saved_reg = sreg;
1229 
1230   last_reg_save_label = label;
1231 }
1232 
1233 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES.  */
1234 
1235 static void
flush_queued_reg_saves(void)1236 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1237 {
1238   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1239 
1240   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1241     {
1242       size_t i;
1243       unsigned int reg, sreg;
1244 
1245       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1246 	if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1247 	  break;
1248       if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1249 	{
1250 	  gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1251 	  num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1252 	}
1253       if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1254 	{
1255 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1256 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1257 	}
1258 
1259       reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1260       if (q->saved_reg)
1261 	sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1262       else
1263 	sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1264       reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1265     }
1266 
1267   queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1268   last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1269 }
1270 
1271 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1272    location for?  Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1273    said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1274    have a new location for?  */
1275 
1276 static bool
clobbers_queued_reg_save(rtx insn)1277 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1278 {
1279   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1280 
1281   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1282     {
1283       size_t i;
1284       if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1285 	return true;
1286       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1287 	if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1288 	    && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1289 	  return true;
1290     }
1291 
1292   return false;
1293 }
1294 
1295 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second.  */
1296 
1297 void
dwarf2out_reg_save_reg(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg)1298 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1299 {
1300   size_t i;
1301   unsigned int regno, sregno;
1302 
1303   for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1304     if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1305       break;
1306   if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1307     {
1308       gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1309       num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1310     }
1311   regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1312   regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1313 
1314   regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1315   sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1316   reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1317 }
1318 
1319 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG?  */
1320 
1321 static rtx
reg_saved_in(rtx reg)1322 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1323 {
1324   unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1325   size_t i;
1326   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1327 
1328   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1329     if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1330       return q->reg;
1331 
1332   for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1333     if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1334 	&& regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1335       return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1336 
1337   return NULL_RTX;
1338 }
1339 
1340 
1341 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1342    or setting up the store_reg.  The "offset" field holds the integer
1343    value, not an offset.  */
1344 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1345 
1346 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1347    which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1348    address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1349    LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1350 
1351    This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1352    cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg.  We describe these rules so
1353    users need not read the source code.
1354 
1355   The High-Level Picture
1356 
1357   Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1358   assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1359   should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1360   work pretty well.  If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1361   enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1362 
1363   Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1364   This is usually SP, but not always.  Again, we deduce that if you
1365   copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1366   then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1367   saves.  This also seems to work.
1368 
1369   Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1370   RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1371   register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1372   had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1373   It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1374   register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1375   that instruction.  If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1376   the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1377   value as in the caller.
1378 
1379   Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1380   offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1381   use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression.  If the offset is 0, we assume that
1382   the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1383 
1384   In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1385   register,
1386 
1387   Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1388 
1389   cfa	       current rule for calculating the CFA.  It usually
1390 	       consists of a register and an offset.
1391   cfa_store    register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1392 	       cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1393 	       cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1394   cfa_temp     register holding an integral value.  cfa_temp.offset
1395 	       stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1396 	       stack pointer.  cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1397 	       to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1398 
1399   Rules  1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1400 	       with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1401 	       cfa.offset.  Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1402 	       cfa_temp.offset.
1403 
1404   Rules  6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1405 	       expression yielding a constant.  This sets cfa_temp.reg
1406 	       and cfa_temp.offset.
1407 
1408   Rule 5:      Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1409 	       stack.
1410 
1411   Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack.  Define offset as the
1412 	       difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1413 	       location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1414 
1415   The Rules
1416 
1417   "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1418   "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1419 
1420   Rule 1:
1421   (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1422   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1423 	   cfa.offset unchanged
1424 	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1425 	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1426 
1427   Rule 2:
1428   (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1429 			      {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1430   effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1431 	   cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1432 	   cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1433 	     if cfa_store.reg==sp
1434 
1435   Rule 3:
1436   (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1437   effects: cfa.reg = fp
1438 	   cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1439 
1440   Rule 4:
1441   (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1442   constraints: <reg1> != fp
1443 	       <reg1> != sp
1444   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1445 	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1446 	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1447 
1448   Rule 5:
1449   (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1450   constraints: <reg1> != fp
1451 	       <reg1> != sp
1452   effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1453 	   cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1454 
1455   Rule 6:
1456   (set <reg> <const_int>)
1457   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1458 	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1459 
1460   Rule 7:
1461   (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1462   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1463 	   cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1464 
1465   Rule 8:
1466   (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1467   effects: none
1468 
1469   Rule 9:
1470   (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1471   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1472 	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1473 
1474   Rule 10:
1475   (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1476   effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1477 	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1478 	   cfa.reg = sp
1479 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1480 
1481   Rule 11:
1482   (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1483   effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1484 	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1485 	   cfa.reg = sp
1486 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1487 
1488   Rule 12:
1489   (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1490 
1491        <reg2>)
1492   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1493 	   cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1494 
1495   Rule 13:
1496   (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1497   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1498 	   cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1499 
1500   Rule 14:
1501   (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1502   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1503 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1504 	   cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1505 
1506   Rule 15:
1507   (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1508   effects: target-dependent  */
1509 
1510 static void
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr(rtx expr,const char * label)1511 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1512 {
1513   rtx src, dest;
1514   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1515 
1516   /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1517      the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1518      it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility.   Other elements
1519      are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1520      flag is set in them.  */
1521   if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1522     {
1523       int par_index;
1524       int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1525 
1526       for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1527 	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1528 	    && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1529 		|| par_index == 0))
1530 	  dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1531 
1532       return;
1533     }
1534 
1535   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1536 
1537   src = SET_SRC (expr);
1538   dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1539 
1540   if (REG_P (src))
1541     {
1542       rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1543       if (rsi)
1544 	src = rsi;
1545     }
1546 
1547   switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1548     {
1549     case REG:
1550       switch (GET_CODE (src))
1551 	{
1552 	  /* Setting FP from SP.  */
1553 	case REG:
1554 	  if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1555 	    {
1556 	      /* Rule 1 */
1557 	      /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP.  Make sure src is
1558 		 relative to the current CFA register.
1559 
1560 		 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1561 		 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1562 		 FP.  So we just rely on the backends to only set
1563 		 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns.  */
1564 	      cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1565 	      cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1566 	      cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1567 	    }
1568 	  else
1569 	    {
1570 	      /* Saving a register in a register.  */
1571 	      gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1572 			  /* For the SPARC and its register window.  */
1573 			  || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1574 			      == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1575 	      queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1576 	    }
1577 	  break;
1578 
1579 	case PLUS:
1580 	case MINUS:
1581 	case LO_SUM:
1582 	  if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1583 	    {
1584 	      /* Rule 2 */
1585 	      /* Adjusting SP.  */
1586 	      switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1587 		{
1588 		case CONST_INT:
1589 		  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1590 		  break;
1591 		case REG:
1592 		  gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1593 			      == cfa_temp.reg);
1594 		  offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1595 		  break;
1596 		default:
1597 		  gcc_unreachable ();
1598 		}
1599 
1600 	      if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1601 		{
1602 		  /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue.  */
1603 		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1604 		  cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1605 		}
1606 	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1607 		/* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp.  */
1608 		;
1609 	      else
1610 		gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1611 
1612 	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1613 		offset = -offset;
1614 	      if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1615 		cfa.offset += offset;
1616 	      if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1617 		cfa_store.offset += offset;
1618 	    }
1619 	  else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1620 	    {
1621 	      /* Rule 3 */
1622 	      /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1623 		 or adjusting the FP */
1624 	      gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1625 
1626 	      gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1627 			  && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1628 			  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1629 	      offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1630 	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1631 		offset = -offset;
1632 	      cfa.offset += offset;
1633 	      cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1634 	    }
1635 	  else
1636 	    {
1637 	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1638 
1639 	      /* Rule 4 */
1640 	      if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1641 		  && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1642 		  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1643 		{
1644 		  /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1645 		     into the FP later on.  */
1646 		  offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1647 		  cfa.offset += offset;
1648 		  cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1649 		  /* Or used to save regs to the stack.  */
1650 		  cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1651 		  cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1652 		}
1653 
1654 	      /* Rule 5 */
1655 	      else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1656 		       && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1657 		       && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1658 		{
1659 		  /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1660 		     of SP for saving registers to the stack.  */
1661 		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1662 		  cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1663 		  cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1664 		}
1665 
1666 	      /* Rule 9 */
1667 	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1668 		       && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1669 		{
1670 		  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1671 		  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1672 		}
1673 	      else
1674 		gcc_unreachable ();
1675 	    }
1676 	  break;
1677 
1678 	  /* Rule 6 */
1679 	case CONST_INT:
1680 	  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1681 	  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1682 	  break;
1683 
1684 	  /* Rule 7 */
1685 	case IOR:
1686 	  gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1687 		      && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1688 		      && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1689 
1690 	  if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1691 	    cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1692 	  cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1693 	  break;
1694 
1695 	  /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1696 	     which will fill in all of the bits.  */
1697 	  /* Rule 8 */
1698 	case HIGH:
1699 	  break;
1700 
1701 	  /* Rule 15 */
1702 	case UNSPEC:
1703 	case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1704 	  gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1705 	  targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1706 	  return;
1707 
1708 	default:
1709 	  gcc_unreachable ();
1710 	}
1711 
1712       def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1713       break;
1714 
1715     case MEM:
1716       gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1717 
1718       /* Saving a register to the stack.  Make sure dest is relative to the
1719 	 CFA register.  */
1720       switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1721 	{
1722 	  /* Rule 10 */
1723 	  /* With a push.  */
1724 	case PRE_MODIFY:
1725 	  /* We can't handle variable size modifications.  */
1726 	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1727 		      == CONST_INT);
1728 	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1729 
1730 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1731 		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1732 
1733 	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1734 	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1735 	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1736 
1737 	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1738 	  break;
1739 
1740 	  /* Rule 11 */
1741 	case PRE_INC:
1742 	case PRE_DEC:
1743 	  offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1744 	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1745 	    offset = -offset;
1746 
1747 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1748 		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1749 
1750 	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1751 	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1752 	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1753 
1754 	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1755 	  break;
1756 
1757 	  /* Rule 12 */
1758 	  /* With an offset.  */
1759 	case PLUS:
1760 	case MINUS:
1761 	case LO_SUM:
1762 	  {
1763 	    int regno;
1764 
1765 	    gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1766 			&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1767 	    offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1768 	    if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1769 	      offset = -offset;
1770 
1771 	    regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1772 
1773 	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1774 	      offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1775 	    else
1776 	      {
1777 		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1778 		offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1779 	      }
1780 	  }
1781 	  break;
1782 
1783 	  /* Rule 13 */
1784 	  /* Without an offset.  */
1785 	case REG:
1786 	  {
1787 	    int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1788 
1789 	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1790 	      offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1791 	    else
1792 	      {
1793 		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1794 		offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1795 	      }
1796 	  }
1797 	  break;
1798 
1799 	  /* Rule 14 */
1800 	case POST_INC:
1801 	  gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1802 		      == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1803 	  offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1804 	  cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1805 	  break;
1806 
1807 	default:
1808 	  gcc_unreachable ();
1809 	}
1810 
1811       if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1812 	  && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1813 	  && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1814 	{
1815 	  /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack.  */
1816 
1817 	  if (cfa.offset == 0)
1818 	    {
1819 	      /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1820 		 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1821 		 on the ARM.  */
1822 	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1823 	      queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1824 	      break;
1825 	    }
1826 	  else
1827 	    {
1828 	      /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1829 		 calculate the CFA.  */
1830 	      rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1831 
1832 	      if (!REG_P (x))
1833 		x = XEXP (x, 0);
1834 	      gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1835 
1836 	      cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1837 	      cfa.base_offset = offset;
1838 	      cfa.indirect = 1;
1839 	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1840 	      break;
1841 	    }
1842 	}
1843 
1844       def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1845       queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1846       break;
1847 
1848     default:
1849       gcc_unreachable ();
1850     }
1851 }
1852 
1853 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1854    sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1855    register to the stack.  If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1856 
1857    If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1858    otherwise after.  Call instructions get invoked twice.  */
1859 
1860 void
dwarf2out_frame_debug(rtx insn,bool after_p)1861 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1862 {
1863   const char *label;
1864   rtx src;
1865 
1866   if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1867     {
1868       size_t i;
1869 
1870       /* Flush any queued register saves.  */
1871       flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1872 
1873       /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info.  */
1874       lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1875       gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1876 		  == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1877 
1878       cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1879       cfa_store = cfa;
1880       cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1881       cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1882 
1883       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1884 	{
1885 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1886 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1887 	}
1888       num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1889       return;
1890     }
1891 
1892   if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1893     flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1894 
1895   if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1896     {
1897       if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1898 	dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1899       return;
1900     }
1901 
1902   label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1903   src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1904   if (src)
1905     insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1906   else
1907     insn = PATTERN (insn);
1908 
1909   dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1910 }
1911 
1912 #endif
1913 
1914 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used.  */
1915 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1916  (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1917 
1918 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1919 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1920 {
1921   switch (cfi)
1922     {
1923     case DW_CFA_nop:
1924     case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1925       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1926 
1927     case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1928     case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1929     case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1930     case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1931     case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1932       return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1933 
1934     case DW_CFA_offset:
1935     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1936     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1937     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1938     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1939     case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1940     case DW_CFA_undefined:
1941     case DW_CFA_same_value:
1942     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1943     case DW_CFA_register:
1944       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1945 
1946     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1947     case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1948     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1949       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1950 
1951     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1952     case DW_CFA_expression:
1953       return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1954 
1955     default:
1956       gcc_unreachable ();
1957     }
1958 }
1959 
1960 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used.  */
1961 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1962  (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1963 
1964 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1965 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1966 {
1967   switch (cfi)
1968     {
1969     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1970     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1971     case DW_CFA_offset:
1972     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1973     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1974       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1975 
1976     case DW_CFA_register:
1977       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1978 
1979     default:
1980       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1981     }
1982 }
1983 
1984 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1985 
1986 /* Switch to eh_frame_section.  If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1987    switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1988    for collect2.  */
1989 
1990 static void
switch_to_eh_frame_section(void)1991 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1992 {
1993   tree label;
1994 
1995 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1996   if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1997     {
1998       int flags;
1999 
2000       if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2001 	{
2002 	  int fde_encoding;
2003 	  int per_encoding;
2004 	  int lsda_encoding;
2005 
2006 	  fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2007 						       /*global=*/0);
2008 	  per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2009 						       /*global=*/1);
2010 	  lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2011 							/*global=*/0);
2012 	  flags = ((! flag_pic
2013 		    || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2014 			&& (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2015 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2016 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2017 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2018 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2019 		   ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2020 	}
2021       else
2022 	flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2023       eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2024     }
2025 #endif
2026 
2027   if (eh_frame_section)
2028     switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2029   else
2030     {
2031       /* We have no special eh_frame section.  Put the information in
2032 	 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2.  */
2033       switch_to_section (data_section);
2034       label = get_file_function_name ('F');
2035       ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2036       targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2037 				       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2038       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2039     }
2040 }
2041 
2042 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s).  */
2043 
2044 static void
output_cfi(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_fde_ref fde,int for_eh)2045 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2046 {
2047   unsigned long r;
2048   if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2049     dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2050 			     | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2051 			 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2052 			 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2053   else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2054     {
2055       r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2056       dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2057 			   "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2058       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2059     }
2060   else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2061     {
2062       r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2063       dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2064 			   "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2065     }
2066   else
2067     {
2068       dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2069 			   "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2070 
2071       switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2072 	{
2073 	case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2074 	  if (for_eh)
2075 	    dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2076 		ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2077 		gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2078 		false, NULL);
2079 	  else
2080 	    dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2081 				 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2082 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2083 	  break;
2084 
2085 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2086 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2087 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2088 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2089 	  break;
2090 
2091 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2092 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2093 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2094 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2095 	  break;
2096 
2097 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2098 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2099 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2100 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2101 	  break;
2102 
2103 	case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2104 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2105 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2106 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2107 	  break;
2108 
2109 	case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2110 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2111 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2112 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2113 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2114 	  break;
2115 
2116 	case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2117 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2118 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2119 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2120 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2121 	  break;
2122 
2123 	case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2124 	case DW_CFA_undefined:
2125 	case DW_CFA_same_value:
2126 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2127 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2128 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2129 	  break;
2130 
2131 	case DW_CFA_register:
2132 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2133 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2134 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2135 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2136 	  break;
2137 
2138 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2139 	case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2140 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2141 	  break;
2142 
2143 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2144 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2145 	  break;
2146 
2147 	case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2148 	  break;
2149 
2150 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2151 	case DW_CFA_expression:
2152 	  output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2153 	  break;
2154 
2155 	case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2156 	  /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf.  */
2157 	  gcc_unreachable ();
2158 
2159 	default:
2160 	  break;
2161 	}
2162     }
2163 }
2164 
2165 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2166    that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2167    location of saved registers.  */
2168 
2169 static void
output_call_frame_info(int for_eh)2170 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2171 {
2172   unsigned int i;
2173   dw_fde_ref fde;
2174   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2175   char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2176   bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2177   char augmentation[6];
2178   int augmentation_size;
2179   int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2180   int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2181   int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2182   int return_reg;
2183 
2184   /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs.  */
2185   if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2186     return;
2187 
2188   /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2189      an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted.  We want to avoid
2190      having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2191      discarded.  Example where this matters: a primary function
2192      template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2193      specialization doesn't.  */
2194   if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2195       && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2196 /* APPLE LOCAL begin for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2197       && flag_exceptions
2198 /* APPLE LOCAL end for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2199       && for_eh)
2200     for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2201       if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2202           && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2203 	  && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2204 	targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2205 				      for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2206 
2207   /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2208      emit any EH unwind information.  Note that if exceptions aren't
2209      enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2210      asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info.  */
2211   if (for_eh)
2212     {
2213       bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2214 
2215       for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2216 	if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2217 	  any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2218         else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2219 	  any_eh_needed = true;
2220 	else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2221 		 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2222 	  any_eh_needed = true;
2223 
2224       if (! any_eh_needed)
2225 	return;
2226     }
2227 
2228   /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app.  */
2229   if (flag_debug_asm)
2230     app_enable ();
2231 
2232   if (for_eh)
2233     switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2234   else
2235     {
2236       if (!debug_frame_section)
2237 	debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2238 					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2239       switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2240     }
2241 
2242   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2243   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2244 
2245   /* Output the CIE.  */
2246   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2247   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2248   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2249     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2250       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2251   dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2252 			"Length of Common Information Entry");
2253   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2254 
2255   /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2256      use 0 to identify the CIE.  */
2257   dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2258 		       (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2259 		       "CIE Identifier Tag");
2260 
2261   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2262 
2263   augmentation[0] = 0;
2264   augmentation_size = 0;
2265   if (for_eh)
2266     {
2267       char *p;
2268 
2269       /* Augmentation:
2270 	 z	Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2271 		augmentation section.
2272 	 L	Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2273 		an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2274 	 R	Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2275 		FDE code pointers.
2276 	 P	Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2277 		personality routine in the CIE augmentation.  */
2278 
2279       fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2280       per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2281       lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2282 
2283       p = augmentation + 1;
2284       if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2285 	{
2286 	  *p++ = 'P';
2287 	  augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2288 	}
2289       if (any_lsda_needed)
2290 	{
2291 	  *p++ = 'L';
2292 	  augmentation_size += 1;
2293 	}
2294       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2295 	{
2296 	  *p++ = 'R';
2297 	  augmentation_size += 1;
2298 	}
2299       if (p > augmentation + 1)
2300 	{
2301 	  augmentation[0] = 'z';
2302 	  *p = '\0';
2303 	}
2304 
2305       /* Ug.  Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all.  */
2306       if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2307 	{
2308 	  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2309 			+ 4		/* CIE Id */
2310 			+ 1		/* CIE version */
2311 			+ strlen (augmentation) + 1	/* Augmentation */
2312 			+ size_of_uleb128 (1)		/* Code alignment */
2313 			+ size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2314 			+ 1		/* RA column */
2315 			+ 1		/* Augmentation size */
2316 			+ 1		/* Personality encoding */ );
2317 	  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2318 
2319 	  augmentation_size += pad;
2320 
2321 	  /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2322 	     iterate for a solution.  Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte.  */
2323 	  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2324 	}
2325     }
2326 
2327   dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2328   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2329   dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2330 			       "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2331 
2332   return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2333   if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2334     dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2335   else
2336     dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2337 
2338   if (augmentation[0])
2339     {
2340       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2341       if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2342 	{
2343 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2344 			       eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2345 	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2346 					   eh_personality_libfunc,
2347 					   true, NULL);
2348 	}
2349 
2350       if (any_lsda_needed)
2351 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2352 			     eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2353 
2354       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2355 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2356 			     eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2357     }
2358 
2359   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2360     output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2361 
2362   /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2363   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2364 		    floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2365   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2366 
2367   /* Loop through all of the FDE's.  */
2368   for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2369     {
2370       fde = &fde_table[i];
2371 
2372       /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it.  */
2373       if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2374 	  && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2375 	  && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2376 	  && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2377 	continue;
2378 
2379       targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2380       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2381       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2382       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2383       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2384 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2385 			     "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2386       dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2387 			    "FDE Length");
2388       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2389 
2390       if (for_eh)
2391 	dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2392       else
2393 	dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2394 			       debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2395 
2396       if (for_eh)
2397 	{
2398 	  rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2399 	  SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2400 	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2401 					   sym_ref,
2402 					   false,
2403 					   "FDE initial location");
2404 	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2405 	    {
2406 	      rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2407 				      fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2408 	      rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2409 				      fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2410 	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2411 	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2412 	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2413 					       "FDE initial location");
2414 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2415 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2416 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2417 				    "FDE address range");
2418 	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2419 					       "FDE initial location");
2420 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2421 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2422 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2423 				    "FDE address range");
2424 	    }
2425 	  else
2426 	    dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2427 				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2428 				  "FDE address range");
2429 	}
2430       else
2431 	{
2432 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2433 			       "FDE initial location");
2434 	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2435 	    {
2436 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2437 				   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2438 				   "FDE initial location");
2439 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2440 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2441 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2442 				    "FDE address range");
2443 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2444 				   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2445 				   "FDE initial location");
2446 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2447 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2448 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2449 				    "FDE address range");
2450 	    }
2451 	  else
2452 	    dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2453 				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2454 				  "FDE address range");
2455 	}
2456 
2457       if (augmentation[0])
2458 	{
2459 	  if (any_lsda_needed)
2460 	    {
2461 	      int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2462 
2463 	      if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2464 		{
2465 		  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2466 				+ 4		/* CIE offset */
2467 				+ 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2468 				+ 1		/* Augmentation size */ );
2469 		  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2470 
2471 		  size += pad;
2472 		  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2473 		}
2474 
2475 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2476 
2477 	      if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2478 		{
2479 		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2480 					       fde->funcdef_number);
2481 		  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2482 			lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2483 			false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2484 		}
2485 	      else
2486 		{
2487 		  if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2488 		    ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2489 		  dw2_asm_output_data
2490 		    (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2491 		     "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2492 		}
2493 	    }
2494 	  else
2495 	    dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2496 	}
2497 
2498       /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2499 	 this FDE.  */
2500       fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2501       for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2502 	output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2503 
2504       /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2505       ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2506 			floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2507       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2508     }
2509 
2510   if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2511     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2512 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2513   /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2514      get a value of 0.  Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it.  */
2515   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2516 #endif
2517 
2518   /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker.  */
2519   if (flag_debug_asm)
2520     app_disable ();
2521 }
2522 
2523 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2524    the prologue.  */
2525 
2526 void
dwarf2out_begin_prologue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2527 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2528 			  const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2529 {
2530   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2531   char * dup_label;
2532   dw_fde_ref fde;
2533 
2534   current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2535 
2536 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2537   /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2538      for call-site information.  We must emit this label if it might
2539      be used.  */
2540   if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2541       && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2542     return;
2543 #else
2544   if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2545     return;
2546 #endif
2547 
2548   switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2549   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2550 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2551   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2552 			  current_function_funcdef_no);
2553   dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2554   current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2555 
2556 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2557   /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info.  */
2558   if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2559     return;
2560 #endif
2561 
2562   /* Expand the fde table if necessary.  */
2563   if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2564     {
2565       fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2566       fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2567 			       fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2568       memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2569 	      FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2570     }
2571 
2572   /* Record the FDE associated with this function.  */
2573   current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2574 
2575   /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table.  */
2576   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2577   fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2578   fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2579   fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2580   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2581   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2582   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2583   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2584   fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2585   fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2586   fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2587   fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2588   fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2589   fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2590   fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2591 
2592   args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2593 
2594   /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2595      prologue case, not the eh frame case.  */
2596 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2597   if (file)
2598     dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2599 #endif
2600 }
2601 
2602 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2603    for a function definition.  This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2604    been generated.  */
2605 
2606 void
dwarf2out_end_epilogue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2607 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2608 			const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2609 {
2610   dw_fde_ref fde;
2611   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2612 
2613   /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2614      function.  */
2615   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2616 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2617   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2618   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2619   fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2620 }
2621 
2622 void
dwarf2out_frame_init(void)2623 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2624 {
2625   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table.  */
2626   fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2627   fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2628   fde_table_in_use = 0;
2629 
2630   /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's.  Do it now for the
2631      sake of lookup_cfa.  */
2632 
2633   /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP.  */
2634   dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2635 
2636 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2637   if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2638     initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2639 #endif
2640 }
2641 
2642 void
dwarf2out_frame_finish(void)2643 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2644 {
2645   /* Output call frame information.  */
2646   if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2647     output_call_frame_info (0);
2648 
2649 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2650   /* Output another copy for the unwinder.  */
2651   if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2652     output_call_frame_info (1);
2653 #endif
2654 }
2655 #endif
2656 
2657 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2658    for emitting location expressions.  */
2659 
2660 /* Data about a single source file.  */
2661 struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2662 {
2663   const char * filename;
2664   int emitted_number;
2665 };
2666 
2667 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2668    relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation.  */
2669 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr		(0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2670 
2671 
2672 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2673 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2674 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2675 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2676 
2677 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs.  Values
2678    can take on several forms.  The forms that are used in this
2679    implementation are listed below.  */
2680 
2681 enum dw_val_class
2682 {
2683   dw_val_class_addr,
2684   dw_val_class_offset,
2685   dw_val_class_loc,
2686   dw_val_class_loc_list,
2687   dw_val_class_range_list,
2688   dw_val_class_const,
2689   dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2690   dw_val_class_long_long,
2691   dw_val_class_vec,
2692   dw_val_class_flag,
2693   dw_val_class_die_ref,
2694   dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2695   dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2696   dw_val_class_lineptr,
2697   dw_val_class_str,
2698   dw_val_class_macptr,
2699   dw_val_class_file
2700 };
2701 
2702 /* Describe a double word constant value.  */
2703 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE.  */
2704 
2705 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2706 {
2707   unsigned long hi;
2708   unsigned long low;
2709 }
2710 dw_long_long_const;
2711 
2712 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value.  */
2713 
2714 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2715 {
2716   unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2717   unsigned length;
2718   unsigned elt_size;
2719 }
2720 dw_vec_const;
2721 
2722 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2723    represented internally.  */
2724 
2725 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2726 {
2727   enum dw_val_class val_class;
2728   union dw_val_struct_union
2729     {
2730       rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2731       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2732       dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2733       dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2734       HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2735       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2736       dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2737       dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2738       struct dw_val_die_union
2739 	{
2740 	  dw_die_ref die;
2741 	  int external;
2742 	} GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2743       unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2744       struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2745       char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2746       unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2747       struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2748     }
2749   GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2750 }
2751 dw_val_node;
2752 
2753 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2754    operations.  */
2755 
2756 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2757 {
2758   dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2759   enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2760   dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2761   dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2762   int dw_loc_addr;
2763 }
2764 dw_loc_descr_node;
2765 
2766 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2767    so you can track variables that are in different places over
2768    their entire life.  */
2769 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2770 {
2771   dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2772   const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2773   const char *end;  /* Label for end address of range */
2774   char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2775 		      Only on head of list */
2776   const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2777   dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2778 } dw_loc_list_node;
2779 
2780 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2781 
2782 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2783 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2784 				       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2785 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2786 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2787 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2788 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2789 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2790 
2791 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name.  */
2792 
2793 static const char *
dwarf_stack_op_name(unsigned int op)2794 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2795 {
2796   switch (op)
2797     {
2798     case DW_OP_addr:
2799     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2800       return "DW_OP_addr";
2801     case DW_OP_deref:
2802       return "DW_OP_deref";
2803     case DW_OP_const1u:
2804       return "DW_OP_const1u";
2805     case DW_OP_const1s:
2806       return "DW_OP_const1s";
2807     case DW_OP_const2u:
2808       return "DW_OP_const2u";
2809     case DW_OP_const2s:
2810       return "DW_OP_const2s";
2811     case DW_OP_const4u:
2812       return "DW_OP_const4u";
2813     case DW_OP_const4s:
2814       return "DW_OP_const4s";
2815     case DW_OP_const8u:
2816       return "DW_OP_const8u";
2817     case DW_OP_const8s:
2818       return "DW_OP_const8s";
2819     case DW_OP_constu:
2820       return "DW_OP_constu";
2821     case DW_OP_consts:
2822       return "DW_OP_consts";
2823     case DW_OP_dup:
2824       return "DW_OP_dup";
2825     case DW_OP_drop:
2826       return "DW_OP_drop";
2827     case DW_OP_over:
2828       return "DW_OP_over";
2829     case DW_OP_pick:
2830       return "DW_OP_pick";
2831     case DW_OP_swap:
2832       return "DW_OP_swap";
2833     case DW_OP_rot:
2834       return "DW_OP_rot";
2835     case DW_OP_xderef:
2836       return "DW_OP_xderef";
2837     case DW_OP_abs:
2838       return "DW_OP_abs";
2839     case DW_OP_and:
2840       return "DW_OP_and";
2841     case DW_OP_div:
2842       return "DW_OP_div";
2843     case DW_OP_minus:
2844       return "DW_OP_minus";
2845     case DW_OP_mod:
2846       return "DW_OP_mod";
2847     case DW_OP_mul:
2848       return "DW_OP_mul";
2849     case DW_OP_neg:
2850       return "DW_OP_neg";
2851     case DW_OP_not:
2852       return "DW_OP_not";
2853     case DW_OP_or:
2854       return "DW_OP_or";
2855     case DW_OP_plus:
2856       return "DW_OP_plus";
2857     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2858       return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2859     case DW_OP_shl:
2860       return "DW_OP_shl";
2861     case DW_OP_shr:
2862       return "DW_OP_shr";
2863     case DW_OP_shra:
2864       return "DW_OP_shra";
2865     case DW_OP_xor:
2866       return "DW_OP_xor";
2867     case DW_OP_bra:
2868       return "DW_OP_bra";
2869     case DW_OP_eq:
2870       return "DW_OP_eq";
2871     case DW_OP_ge:
2872       return "DW_OP_ge";
2873     case DW_OP_gt:
2874       return "DW_OP_gt";
2875     case DW_OP_le:
2876       return "DW_OP_le";
2877     case DW_OP_lt:
2878       return "DW_OP_lt";
2879     case DW_OP_ne:
2880       return "DW_OP_ne";
2881     case DW_OP_skip:
2882       return "DW_OP_skip";
2883     case DW_OP_lit0:
2884       return "DW_OP_lit0";
2885     case DW_OP_lit1:
2886       return "DW_OP_lit1";
2887     case DW_OP_lit2:
2888       return "DW_OP_lit2";
2889     case DW_OP_lit3:
2890       return "DW_OP_lit3";
2891     case DW_OP_lit4:
2892       return "DW_OP_lit4";
2893     case DW_OP_lit5:
2894       return "DW_OP_lit5";
2895     case DW_OP_lit6:
2896       return "DW_OP_lit6";
2897     case DW_OP_lit7:
2898       return "DW_OP_lit7";
2899     case DW_OP_lit8:
2900       return "DW_OP_lit8";
2901     case DW_OP_lit9:
2902       return "DW_OP_lit9";
2903     case DW_OP_lit10:
2904       return "DW_OP_lit10";
2905     case DW_OP_lit11:
2906       return "DW_OP_lit11";
2907     case DW_OP_lit12:
2908       return "DW_OP_lit12";
2909     case DW_OP_lit13:
2910       return "DW_OP_lit13";
2911     case DW_OP_lit14:
2912       return "DW_OP_lit14";
2913     case DW_OP_lit15:
2914       return "DW_OP_lit15";
2915     case DW_OP_lit16:
2916       return "DW_OP_lit16";
2917     case DW_OP_lit17:
2918       return "DW_OP_lit17";
2919     case DW_OP_lit18:
2920       return "DW_OP_lit18";
2921     case DW_OP_lit19:
2922       return "DW_OP_lit19";
2923     case DW_OP_lit20:
2924       return "DW_OP_lit20";
2925     case DW_OP_lit21:
2926       return "DW_OP_lit21";
2927     case DW_OP_lit22:
2928       return "DW_OP_lit22";
2929     case DW_OP_lit23:
2930       return "DW_OP_lit23";
2931     case DW_OP_lit24:
2932       return "DW_OP_lit24";
2933     case DW_OP_lit25:
2934       return "DW_OP_lit25";
2935     case DW_OP_lit26:
2936       return "DW_OP_lit26";
2937     case DW_OP_lit27:
2938       return "DW_OP_lit27";
2939     case DW_OP_lit28:
2940       return "DW_OP_lit28";
2941     case DW_OP_lit29:
2942       return "DW_OP_lit29";
2943     case DW_OP_lit30:
2944       return "DW_OP_lit30";
2945     case DW_OP_lit31:
2946       return "DW_OP_lit31";
2947     case DW_OP_reg0:
2948       return "DW_OP_reg0";
2949     case DW_OP_reg1:
2950       return "DW_OP_reg1";
2951     case DW_OP_reg2:
2952       return "DW_OP_reg2";
2953     case DW_OP_reg3:
2954       return "DW_OP_reg3";
2955     case DW_OP_reg4:
2956       return "DW_OP_reg4";
2957     case DW_OP_reg5:
2958       return "DW_OP_reg5";
2959     case DW_OP_reg6:
2960       return "DW_OP_reg6";
2961     case DW_OP_reg7:
2962       return "DW_OP_reg7";
2963     case DW_OP_reg8:
2964       return "DW_OP_reg8";
2965     case DW_OP_reg9:
2966       return "DW_OP_reg9";
2967     case DW_OP_reg10:
2968       return "DW_OP_reg10";
2969     case DW_OP_reg11:
2970       return "DW_OP_reg11";
2971     case DW_OP_reg12:
2972       return "DW_OP_reg12";
2973     case DW_OP_reg13:
2974       return "DW_OP_reg13";
2975     case DW_OP_reg14:
2976       return "DW_OP_reg14";
2977     case DW_OP_reg15:
2978       return "DW_OP_reg15";
2979     case DW_OP_reg16:
2980       return "DW_OP_reg16";
2981     case DW_OP_reg17:
2982       return "DW_OP_reg17";
2983     case DW_OP_reg18:
2984       return "DW_OP_reg18";
2985     case DW_OP_reg19:
2986       return "DW_OP_reg19";
2987     case DW_OP_reg20:
2988       return "DW_OP_reg20";
2989     case DW_OP_reg21:
2990       return "DW_OP_reg21";
2991     case DW_OP_reg22:
2992       return "DW_OP_reg22";
2993     case DW_OP_reg23:
2994       return "DW_OP_reg23";
2995     case DW_OP_reg24:
2996       return "DW_OP_reg24";
2997     case DW_OP_reg25:
2998       return "DW_OP_reg25";
2999     case DW_OP_reg26:
3000       return "DW_OP_reg26";
3001     case DW_OP_reg27:
3002       return "DW_OP_reg27";
3003     case DW_OP_reg28:
3004       return "DW_OP_reg28";
3005     case DW_OP_reg29:
3006       return "DW_OP_reg29";
3007     case DW_OP_reg30:
3008       return "DW_OP_reg30";
3009     case DW_OP_reg31:
3010       return "DW_OP_reg31";
3011     case DW_OP_breg0:
3012       return "DW_OP_breg0";
3013     case DW_OP_breg1:
3014       return "DW_OP_breg1";
3015     case DW_OP_breg2:
3016       return "DW_OP_breg2";
3017     case DW_OP_breg3:
3018       return "DW_OP_breg3";
3019     case DW_OP_breg4:
3020       return "DW_OP_breg4";
3021     case DW_OP_breg5:
3022       return "DW_OP_breg5";
3023     case DW_OP_breg6:
3024       return "DW_OP_breg6";
3025     case DW_OP_breg7:
3026       return "DW_OP_breg7";
3027     case DW_OP_breg8:
3028       return "DW_OP_breg8";
3029     case DW_OP_breg9:
3030       return "DW_OP_breg9";
3031     case DW_OP_breg10:
3032       return "DW_OP_breg10";
3033     case DW_OP_breg11:
3034       return "DW_OP_breg11";
3035     case DW_OP_breg12:
3036       return "DW_OP_breg12";
3037     case DW_OP_breg13:
3038       return "DW_OP_breg13";
3039     case DW_OP_breg14:
3040       return "DW_OP_breg14";
3041     case DW_OP_breg15:
3042       return "DW_OP_breg15";
3043     case DW_OP_breg16:
3044       return "DW_OP_breg16";
3045     case DW_OP_breg17:
3046       return "DW_OP_breg17";
3047     case DW_OP_breg18:
3048       return "DW_OP_breg18";
3049     case DW_OP_breg19:
3050       return "DW_OP_breg19";
3051     case DW_OP_breg20:
3052       return "DW_OP_breg20";
3053     case DW_OP_breg21:
3054       return "DW_OP_breg21";
3055     case DW_OP_breg22:
3056       return "DW_OP_breg22";
3057     case DW_OP_breg23:
3058       return "DW_OP_breg23";
3059     case DW_OP_breg24:
3060       return "DW_OP_breg24";
3061     case DW_OP_breg25:
3062       return "DW_OP_breg25";
3063     case DW_OP_breg26:
3064       return "DW_OP_breg26";
3065     case DW_OP_breg27:
3066       return "DW_OP_breg27";
3067     case DW_OP_breg28:
3068       return "DW_OP_breg28";
3069     case DW_OP_breg29:
3070       return "DW_OP_breg29";
3071     case DW_OP_breg30:
3072       return "DW_OP_breg30";
3073     case DW_OP_breg31:
3074       return "DW_OP_breg31";
3075     case DW_OP_regx:
3076       return "DW_OP_regx";
3077     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3078       return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3079     case DW_OP_bregx:
3080       return "DW_OP_bregx";
3081     case DW_OP_piece:
3082       return "DW_OP_piece";
3083     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3084       return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3085     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3086       return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3087     case DW_OP_nop:
3088       return "DW_OP_nop";
3089     case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3090       return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3091     case DW_OP_call2:
3092       return "DW_OP_call2";
3093     case DW_OP_call4:
3094       return "DW_OP_call4";
3095     case DW_OP_call_ref:
3096       return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3097     case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3098       return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3099     default:
3100       return "OP_<unknown>";
3101     }
3102 }
3103 
3104 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description.  Location
3105    descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3106    together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions.  */
3107 
3108 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
new_loc_descr(enum dwarf_location_atom op,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)3109 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3110 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3111 {
3112   dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3113 
3114   descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3115   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3116   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3117   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3118   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3119 
3120   return descr;
3121 }
3122 
3123 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression.  */
3124 
3125 static inline void
add_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)3126 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3127 {
3128   dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3129 
3130   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
3131   for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3132     ;
3133 
3134   *d = descr;
3135 }
3136 
3137 /* Return the size of a location descriptor.  */
3138 
3139 static unsigned long
size_of_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3140 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3141 {
3142   unsigned long size = 1;
3143 
3144   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3145     {
3146     case DW_OP_addr:
3147     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3148       size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3149       break;
3150     case DW_OP_const1u:
3151     case DW_OP_const1s:
3152       size += 1;
3153       break;
3154     case DW_OP_const2u:
3155     case DW_OP_const2s:
3156       size += 2;
3157       break;
3158     case DW_OP_const4u:
3159     case DW_OP_const4s:
3160       size += 4;
3161       break;
3162     case DW_OP_const8u:
3163     case DW_OP_const8s:
3164       size += 8;
3165       break;
3166     case DW_OP_constu:
3167       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3168       break;
3169     case DW_OP_consts:
3170       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3171       break;
3172     case DW_OP_pick:
3173       size += 1;
3174       break;
3175     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3176       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3177       break;
3178     case DW_OP_skip:
3179     case DW_OP_bra:
3180       size += 2;
3181       break;
3182     case DW_OP_breg0:
3183     case DW_OP_breg1:
3184     case DW_OP_breg2:
3185     case DW_OP_breg3:
3186     case DW_OP_breg4:
3187     case DW_OP_breg5:
3188     case DW_OP_breg6:
3189     case DW_OP_breg7:
3190     case DW_OP_breg8:
3191     case DW_OP_breg9:
3192     case DW_OP_breg10:
3193     case DW_OP_breg11:
3194     case DW_OP_breg12:
3195     case DW_OP_breg13:
3196     case DW_OP_breg14:
3197     case DW_OP_breg15:
3198     case DW_OP_breg16:
3199     case DW_OP_breg17:
3200     case DW_OP_breg18:
3201     case DW_OP_breg19:
3202     case DW_OP_breg20:
3203     case DW_OP_breg21:
3204     case DW_OP_breg22:
3205     case DW_OP_breg23:
3206     case DW_OP_breg24:
3207     case DW_OP_breg25:
3208     case DW_OP_breg26:
3209     case DW_OP_breg27:
3210     case DW_OP_breg28:
3211     case DW_OP_breg29:
3212     case DW_OP_breg30:
3213     case DW_OP_breg31:
3214       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3215       break;
3216     case DW_OP_regx:
3217       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3218       break;
3219     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3220       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3221       break;
3222     case DW_OP_bregx:
3223       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3224       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3225       break;
3226     case DW_OP_piece:
3227       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3228       break;
3229     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3230     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3231       size += 1;
3232       break;
3233     case DW_OP_call2:
3234       size += 2;
3235       break;
3236     case DW_OP_call4:
3237       size += 4;
3238       break;
3239     case DW_OP_call_ref:
3240       size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3241       break;
3242     default:
3243       break;
3244     }
3245 
3246   return size;
3247 }
3248 
3249 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors.  */
3250 
3251 static unsigned long
size_of_locs(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3252 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3253 {
3254   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3255   unsigned long size;
3256 
3257   /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3258      field, to avoid writing to a PCH file.  */
3259   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3260     {
3261       if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3262 	break;
3263       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3264     }
3265   if (! l)
3266     return size;
3267 
3268   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3269     {
3270       l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3271       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3272     }
3273 
3274   return size;
3275 }
3276 
3277 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).  */
3278 
3279 static void
output_loc_operands(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3280 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3281 {
3282   dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3283   dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3284 
3285   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3286     {
3287 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3288     case DW_OP_addr:
3289       dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3290       break;
3291     case DW_OP_const2u:
3292     case DW_OP_const2s:
3293       dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3294       break;
3295     case DW_OP_const4u:
3296     case DW_OP_const4s:
3297       dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3298       break;
3299     case DW_OP_const8u:
3300     case DW_OP_const8s:
3301       gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3302       dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3303       break;
3304     case DW_OP_skip:
3305     case DW_OP_bra:
3306       {
3307 	int offset;
3308 
3309 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3310 	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3311 
3312 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3313       }
3314       break;
3315 #else
3316     case DW_OP_addr:
3317     case DW_OP_const2u:
3318     case DW_OP_const2s:
3319     case DW_OP_const4u:
3320     case DW_OP_const4s:
3321     case DW_OP_const8u:
3322     case DW_OP_const8s:
3323     case DW_OP_skip:
3324     case DW_OP_bra:
3325       /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3326 	 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3327 	 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3328 	 only doing unwinding.  */
3329       gcc_unreachable ();
3330 #endif
3331     case DW_OP_const1u:
3332     case DW_OP_const1s:
3333       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3334       break;
3335     case DW_OP_constu:
3336       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3337       break;
3338     case DW_OP_consts:
3339       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3340       break;
3341     case DW_OP_pick:
3342       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3343       break;
3344     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3345       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3346       break;
3347     case DW_OP_breg0:
3348     case DW_OP_breg1:
3349     case DW_OP_breg2:
3350     case DW_OP_breg3:
3351     case DW_OP_breg4:
3352     case DW_OP_breg5:
3353     case DW_OP_breg6:
3354     case DW_OP_breg7:
3355     case DW_OP_breg8:
3356     case DW_OP_breg9:
3357     case DW_OP_breg10:
3358     case DW_OP_breg11:
3359     case DW_OP_breg12:
3360     case DW_OP_breg13:
3361     case DW_OP_breg14:
3362     case DW_OP_breg15:
3363     case DW_OP_breg16:
3364     case DW_OP_breg17:
3365     case DW_OP_breg18:
3366     case DW_OP_breg19:
3367     case DW_OP_breg20:
3368     case DW_OP_breg21:
3369     case DW_OP_breg22:
3370     case DW_OP_breg23:
3371     case DW_OP_breg24:
3372     case DW_OP_breg25:
3373     case DW_OP_breg26:
3374     case DW_OP_breg27:
3375     case DW_OP_breg28:
3376     case DW_OP_breg29:
3377     case DW_OP_breg30:
3378     case DW_OP_breg31:
3379       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3380       break;
3381     case DW_OP_regx:
3382       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3383       break;
3384     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3385       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3386       break;
3387     case DW_OP_bregx:
3388       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3389       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3390       break;
3391     case DW_OP_piece:
3392       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3393       break;
3394     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3395     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3396       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3397       break;
3398 
3399     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3400       if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3401 	{
3402 	  targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3403 					       DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3404 					       val1->v.val_addr);
3405 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3406 	}
3407       else
3408 	gcc_unreachable ();
3409       break;
3410 
3411     default:
3412       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
3413       break;
3414     }
3415 }
3416 
3417 /* Output a sequence of location operations.  */
3418 
3419 static void
output_loc_sequence(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3420 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3421 {
3422   for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3423     {
3424       /* Output the opcode.  */
3425       dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3426 			   "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3427 
3428       /* Output the operand(s) (if any).  */
3429       output_loc_operands (loc);
3430     }
3431 }
3432 
3433 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3434    description based on a cfi entry with a complex address.  */
3435 
3436 static void
output_cfa_loc(dw_cfi_ref cfi)3437 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3438 {
3439   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3440   unsigned long size;
3441 
3442   /* Output the size of the block.  */
3443   loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3444   size = size_of_locs (loc);
3445   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3446 
3447   /* Now output the operations themselves.  */
3448   output_loc_sequence (loc);
3449 }
3450 
3451 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3452    dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3453    expression.  */
3454 
3455 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
build_cfa_loc(dw_cfa_location * cfa,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)3456 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3457 {
3458   struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3459 
3460   offset += cfa->offset;
3461 
3462   if (cfa->indirect)
3463     {
3464       if (cfa->base_offset)
3465 	{
3466 	  if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3467 	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3468 	  else
3469 	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3470 	}
3471       else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3472 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3473       else
3474 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3475 
3476       head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3477       tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3478       add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3479       if (offset != 0)
3480 	{
3481 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3482 	  add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3483 	}
3484     }
3485   else
3486     {
3487       if (offset == 0)
3488 	if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3489 	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3490 	else
3491 	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3492       else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3493 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3494       else
3495 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3496     }
3497 
3498   return head;
3499 }
3500 
3501 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3502    descriptor sequence.  */
3503 
3504 static void
get_cfa_from_loc_descr(dw_cfa_location * cfa,struct dw_loc_descr_struct * loc)3505 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3506 {
3507   struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3508   cfa->offset = 0;
3509   cfa->base_offset = 0;
3510   cfa->indirect = 0;
3511   cfa->reg = -1;
3512 
3513   for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3514     {
3515       enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3516 
3517       switch (op)
3518 	{
3519 	case DW_OP_reg0:
3520 	case DW_OP_reg1:
3521 	case DW_OP_reg2:
3522 	case DW_OP_reg3:
3523 	case DW_OP_reg4:
3524 	case DW_OP_reg5:
3525 	case DW_OP_reg6:
3526 	case DW_OP_reg7:
3527 	case DW_OP_reg8:
3528 	case DW_OP_reg9:
3529 	case DW_OP_reg10:
3530 	case DW_OP_reg11:
3531 	case DW_OP_reg12:
3532 	case DW_OP_reg13:
3533 	case DW_OP_reg14:
3534 	case DW_OP_reg15:
3535 	case DW_OP_reg16:
3536 	case DW_OP_reg17:
3537 	case DW_OP_reg18:
3538 	case DW_OP_reg19:
3539 	case DW_OP_reg20:
3540 	case DW_OP_reg21:
3541 	case DW_OP_reg22:
3542 	case DW_OP_reg23:
3543 	case DW_OP_reg24:
3544 	case DW_OP_reg25:
3545 	case DW_OP_reg26:
3546 	case DW_OP_reg27:
3547 	case DW_OP_reg28:
3548 	case DW_OP_reg29:
3549 	case DW_OP_reg30:
3550 	case DW_OP_reg31:
3551 	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3552 	  break;
3553 	case DW_OP_regx:
3554 	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3555 	  break;
3556 	case DW_OP_breg0:
3557 	case DW_OP_breg1:
3558 	case DW_OP_breg2:
3559 	case DW_OP_breg3:
3560 	case DW_OP_breg4:
3561 	case DW_OP_breg5:
3562 	case DW_OP_breg6:
3563 	case DW_OP_breg7:
3564 	case DW_OP_breg8:
3565 	case DW_OP_breg9:
3566 	case DW_OP_breg10:
3567 	case DW_OP_breg11:
3568 	case DW_OP_breg12:
3569 	case DW_OP_breg13:
3570 	case DW_OP_breg14:
3571 	case DW_OP_breg15:
3572 	case DW_OP_breg16:
3573 	case DW_OP_breg17:
3574 	case DW_OP_breg18:
3575 	case DW_OP_breg19:
3576 	case DW_OP_breg20:
3577 	case DW_OP_breg21:
3578 	case DW_OP_breg22:
3579 	case DW_OP_breg23:
3580 	case DW_OP_breg24:
3581 	case DW_OP_breg25:
3582 	case DW_OP_breg26:
3583 	case DW_OP_breg27:
3584 	case DW_OP_breg28:
3585 	case DW_OP_breg29:
3586 	case DW_OP_breg30:
3587 	case DW_OP_breg31:
3588 	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3589 	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3590 	  break;
3591 	case DW_OP_bregx:
3592 	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3593 	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3594 	  break;
3595 	case DW_OP_deref:
3596 	  cfa->indirect = 1;
3597 	  break;
3598 	case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3599 	  cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3600 	  break;
3601 	default:
3602 	  internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3603 			  dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3604 	}
3605     }
3606 }
3607 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3608 
3609 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information.  */
3610 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3611 
3612 /* .debug_str support.  */
3613 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3614 
3615 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3616 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3617 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3618 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3619 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3620 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3621 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3622 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3623 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3624 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3625 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3626 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3627 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3628 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3629 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3630 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3631 
3632 /* The debug hooks structure.  */
3633 
3634 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3635 {
3636   dwarf2out_init,
3637   dwarf2out_finish,
3638   dwarf2out_define,
3639   dwarf2out_undef,
3640   dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3641   dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3642   dwarf2out_begin_block,
3643   dwarf2out_end_block,
3644   dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3645   dwarf2out_source_line,
3646   dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3647   debug_nothing_int_charstar,	/* end_prologue */
3648   dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3649   dwarf2out_begin_function,
3650   debug_nothing_int,		/* end_function */
3651   dwarf2out_decl,		/* function_decl */
3652   dwarf2out_global_decl,
3653   dwarf2out_type_decl,		/* type_decl */
3654   dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3655   debug_nothing_tree,		/* deferred_inline_function */
3656   /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3657      emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3658      something tries to reference them.  */
3659   dwarf2out_abstract_function,	/* outlining_inline_function */
3660   debug_nothing_rtx,		/* label */
3661   debug_nothing_int,		/* handle_pch */
3662   dwarf2out_var_location,
3663   dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3664   1                             /* start_end_main_source_file */
3665 };
3666 #endif
3667 
3668 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3669    "Debugging Information Entries".  This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3670    throughout the remainder of this file.  */
3671 
3672 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3673    walked to generate the DWARF debugging info.  The walk of the internal
3674    representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3675    The types below are used to describe the internal representation.  */
3676 
3677 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3678    .debug_info section to refer to each other.  */
3679 
3680 typedef long int dw_offset;
3681 
3682 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies.  */
3683 
3684 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3685 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3686 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3687 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3688 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3689 
3690 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3691    line number associated with the label generated for that
3692    entry.  The label gives the PC value associated with
3693    the line number entry.  */
3694 
3695 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3696 {
3697   unsigned long dw_file_num;
3698   unsigned long dw_line_num;
3699 }
3700 dw_line_info_entry;
3701 
3702 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3703    own sequence.  */
3704 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3705 {
3706   unsigned long dw_file_num;
3707   unsigned long dw_line_num;
3708   unsigned long function;
3709 }
3710 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3711 
3712 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3713    a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3714    Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify.  */
3715 
3716 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3717 {
3718   enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3719   dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3720 }
3721 dw_attr_node;
3722 
3723 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3724 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3725 
3726 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure.  DIEs form a tree.
3727    The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3728    die_sib.  die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node.  */
3729 
3730 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3731 {
3732   enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3733   char *die_symbol;
3734   VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3735   dw_die_ref die_parent;
3736   dw_die_ref die_child;
3737   dw_die_ref die_sib;
3738   dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3739   dw_offset die_offset;
3740   unsigned long die_abbrev;
3741   int die_mark;
3742   /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused.  */
3743   int die_perennial_p;
3744   unsigned int decl_id;
3745 }
3746 die_node;
3747 
3748 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order.  */
3749 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do {	\
3750   c = die->die_child;				\
3751   if (c) do {					\
3752     c = c->die_sib;				\
3753     expr;					\
3754   } while (c != die->die_child);		\
3755 } while (0)
3756 
3757 /* The pubname structure */
3758 
3759 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3760 {
3761   dw_die_ref die;
3762   char *name;
3763 }
3764 pubname_entry;
3765 
3766 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
3767 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
3768 
3769 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3770 {
3771   int block_num;
3772 };
3773 
3774 /* The limbo die list structure.  */
3775 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3776 {
3777   dw_die_ref die;
3778   tree created_for;
3779   struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3780 }
3781 limbo_die_node;
3782 
3783 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
3784 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3785 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3786 #endif
3787 
3788 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3789    implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3790 
3791    Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3792    TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3793    each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3794    _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3795    These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3796    generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them.  */
3797 
3798 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl)				\
3799   (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE			\
3800    || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)				\
3801        && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))		\
3802        && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))	\
3803 	   /* This is necessary for stub decls that	\
3804 	      appear in nested inline functions.  */	\
3805 	   || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE	\
3806 	       && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl)		\
3807 		   == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3808 
3809 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3810    language, and compiler version.  */
3811 
3812 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header.  */
3813 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3814   (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3815 
3816 /* Fixed size portion of public names info.  */
3817 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3818 
3819 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info.  */
3820 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE					\
3821   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4,	\
3822                 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2)					\
3823    - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3824 
3825 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info.  It must be
3826    aligned to twice the pointer size.  */
3827 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3828   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3829                 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3830    - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3831 
3832 /* Use assembler line directives if available.  */
3833 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3834 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3835 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3836 #else
3837 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3838 #endif
3839 #endif
3840 
3841 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3842    This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values.  */
3843 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE  -10
3844 
3845 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes.  */
3846 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE  10
3847 
3848 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode.  */
3849 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE  (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3850 
3851 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3852    In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3853    the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3854    is not made available by the GCC front-end.  */
3855 #define	DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3856 
3857 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3858 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3859    the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section.  */
3860 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3861 #endif
3862 
3863 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit.  */
3864 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3865 
3866 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated.  */
3867 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3868 
3869 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit.  */
3870 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3871 
3872 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3873    The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl.  */
3874 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3875 
3876 /* Node of the variable location list.  */
3877 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3878 {
3879   rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3880   const char * GTY (()) label;
3881   const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3882   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3883 };
3884 
3885 /* Variable location list.  */
3886 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3887 {
3888   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3889 
3890   /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3891      it is marked through the chain.  */
3892   struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3893 
3894   /* DECL_UID of the variable decl.  */
3895   unsigned int decl_id;
3896 };
3897 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3898 
3899 
3900 /* Table of decl location linked lists.  */
3901 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3902 
3903 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3904    are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3905    children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs.  */
3906 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3907   dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3908 
3909 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table.  */
3910 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3911 
3912 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use.  */
3913 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3914 
3915 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3916    abbrev_die_table.  */
3917 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3918 
3919 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3920    for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit.  */
3921 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3922      dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3923 
3924 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table.  */
3925 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3926 
3927 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use.  */
3928 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3929 
3930 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section.  */
3931 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3932 
3933 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3934    for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit.  */
3935 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3936      dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3937 
3938 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table.  */
3939 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3940 
3941 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use.  */
3942 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3943 
3944 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3945    line_info_table.  */
3946 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3947 
3948 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3949    accessible names.  */
3950 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) *  pubname_table;
3951 
3952 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3953    accessible types.  */
3954 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
3955 
3956 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info.  */
3957 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3958 
3959 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table.  */
3960 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3961 
3962 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use.  */
3963 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3964 
3965 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3966    arange_table.  */
3967 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3968 
3969 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info.  */
3970 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3971 
3972 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table.  */
3973 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3974 
3975 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use.  */
3976 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3977 
3978 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3979    ranges_table.  */
3980 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3981 
3982 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3983 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3984 
3985 /* Unique label counter.  */
3986 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3987 
3988 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3989 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions.  */
3990 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3991 #endif
3992 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3993 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3994 #endif
3995 
3996 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file().  */
3997 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3998 
3999 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym().  */
4000 static GTY(()) int label_num;
4001 
4002 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename.  */
4003 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4004 
4005 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4006 
4007 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4008    within the current function.  */
4009 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4010 
4011 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
4012 
4013 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4014 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4015 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4016 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4017 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4018 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4019 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4020 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4021 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4022 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4023 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4024 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4025 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4026 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4027 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4028 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4029 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4030 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4031 			      unsigned long);
4032 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4033 			       unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4034 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4035 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4036 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4037 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4038 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4039 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4040 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4041 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4042 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4043 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4044 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4045 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4046 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4047 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4048 			     dw_loc_list_ref);
4049 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4050 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4051 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4052 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4053 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4054 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4055 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4056 			   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4057 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4058 			       unsigned long);
4059 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4060 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4061 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4062 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4063 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4064 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4065 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4066 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4067 static bool is_c_family (void);
4068 static bool is_cxx (void);
4069 static bool is_java (void);
4070 static bool is_fortran (void);
4071 static bool is_ada (void);
4072 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4073 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4074 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4075 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4076 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4077 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4078 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4079 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4080 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4081 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4082 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4083 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4084 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4085 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4086 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4087 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4088 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4089 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4090 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4091 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4092 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4093 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4094 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4095 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4096 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4097 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4098 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4099 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4100 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4101 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4102 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4103 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4104 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4105 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4106 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4107 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4108 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4109 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4110 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4111 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4112 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4113 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4114 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4115 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4116 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4117 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4118 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4119 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4120 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4121 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4122 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4123 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4124 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4125 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4126 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4127 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4128 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4129 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4130 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4132 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4133 static void output_aranges (void);
4134 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4135 static void output_ranges (void);
4136 static void output_line_info (void);
4137 static void output_file_names (void);
4138 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4139 static tree root_type (tree);
4140 static int is_base_type (tree);
4141 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4142 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4143 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4144 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4145 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4146 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4147 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4148 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4149 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4150 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4151 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4152 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4153 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4154 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4155 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4156 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4157 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4158 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4159 static tree field_type (tree);
4160 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4161 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4162 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4163 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4164 static void add_AT_location_description	(dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4165 					 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4166 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4167 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4168 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4169 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4170 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4171 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4172 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4173 						   enum dwarf_attribute);
4174 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4175 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4176 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4177 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4178 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4179 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4180 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4181 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4182 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4183 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4184 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4185 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4186 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4187 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4188 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4189 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4190 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4191 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4192 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4193 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4194 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4195 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4196 #if 0
4197 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4198 #endif
4199 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4200 #if 0
4201 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4202 #endif
4203 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4204 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4205 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4206 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4207 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4208 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4209 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4211 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4212 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4213 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4214 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4215 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4216 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4217 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4218 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4219 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4220 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
4221 						enum debug_info_usage);
4222 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4223 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4224 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4225 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4226 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4227 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4228 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4229 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4230 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4231 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4232 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4233 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4234 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4235 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4236 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4237 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4238 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4239 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4240 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4241 				     const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4242 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4243 				       const char *, const char *,
4244 				       const char *);
4245 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4246 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4247 
4248 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4249 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4250 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4251 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4252 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4253 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4254 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4255 
4256 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information.  */
4257 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4258 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION	".debug_info"
4259 #endif
4260 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4261 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION	".debug_abbrev"
4262 #endif
4263 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4264 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION	".debug_aranges"
4265 #endif
4266 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4267 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION	".debug_macinfo"
4268 #endif
4269 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4270 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION	".debug_line"
4271 #endif
4272 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4273 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION	".debug_loc"
4274 #endif
4275 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4276 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION	".debug_pubnames"
4277 #endif
4278 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4279 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION	".debug_str"
4280 #endif
4281 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4282 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION	".debug_ranges"
4283 #endif
4284 
4285 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data.  */
4286 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4287 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME	".text"
4288 #endif
4289 
4290 /* Section flags for .debug_str section.  */
4291 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4292   (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants			\
4293    ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1	\
4294    : SECTION_DEBUG)
4295 
4296 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4297    the section names themselves.  */
4298 
4299 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4300 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL		"Ltext"
4301 #endif
4302 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4303 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL         "Ltext_cold"
4304 #endif
4305 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4306 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_line"
4307 #endif
4308 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4309 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_info"
4310 #endif
4311 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4312 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_abbrev"
4313 #endif
4314 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4315 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL		"Ldebug_loc"
4316 #endif
4317 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4318 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_ranges"
4319 #endif
4320 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4321 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL     "Ldebug_macinfo"
4322 #endif
4323 
4324 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4325    (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4326    options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4327    If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4328    typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary.  */
4329 
4330 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4331 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4332 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4333 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4334 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4335 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4336 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4337 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4338 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4339 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4340 
4341 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4342 #define TEXT_END_LABEL		"Letext"
4343 #endif
4344 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4345 #define COLD_END_LABEL          "Letext_cold"
4346 #endif
4347 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4348 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL	"LBB"
4349 #endif
4350 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4351 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL		"LBE"
4352 #endif
4353 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4354 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL		"LM"
4355 #endif
4356 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4357 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL	"LSM"
4358 #endif
4359 
4360 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4361    called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE.  */
4362 
4363 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4364 
4365 void
dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func(const char * (* func)(const char *))4366 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4367 {
4368   demangle_name_func = func;
4369 }
4370 
4371 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register.  */
4372 
4373 static inline int
is_pseudo_reg(rtx rtl)4374 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4375 {
4376   return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4377 	  || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4378 	      && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4379 }
4380 
4381 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4382    removed.  */
4383 
4384 static inline tree
type_main_variant(tree type)4385 type_main_variant (tree type)
4386 {
4387   type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4388 
4389   /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4390      variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4391      members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4392      front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4393      here.  */
4394   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4395     while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4396       type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4397 
4398   return type;
4399 }
4400 
4401 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type.  */
4402 
4403 static inline int
is_tagged_type(tree type)4404 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4405 {
4406   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4407 
4408   return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4409 	  || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4410 }
4411 
4412 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name.  */
4413 
4414 static const char *
dwarf_tag_name(unsigned int tag)4415 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4416 {
4417   switch (tag)
4418     {
4419     case DW_TAG_padding:
4420       return "DW_TAG_padding";
4421     case DW_TAG_array_type:
4422       return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4423     case DW_TAG_class_type:
4424       return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4425     case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4426       return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4427     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4428       return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4429     case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4430       return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4431     case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4432       return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4433     case DW_TAG_label:
4434       return "DW_TAG_label";
4435     case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4436       return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4437     case DW_TAG_member:
4438       return "DW_TAG_member";
4439     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4440       return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4441     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4442       return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4443     case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4444       return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4445     case DW_TAG_string_type:
4446       return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4447     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4448       return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4449     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4450       return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4451     case DW_TAG_typedef:
4452       return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4453     case DW_TAG_union_type:
4454       return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4455     case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4456       return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4457     case DW_TAG_variant:
4458       return "DW_TAG_variant";
4459     case DW_TAG_common_block:
4460       return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4461     case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4462       return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4463     case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4464       return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4465     case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4466       return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4467     case DW_TAG_module:
4468       return "DW_TAG_module";
4469     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4470       return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4471     case DW_TAG_set_type:
4472       return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4473     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4474       return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4475     case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4476       return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4477     case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4478       return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4479     case DW_TAG_base_type:
4480       return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4481     case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4482       return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4483     case DW_TAG_const_type:
4484       return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4485     case DW_TAG_constant:
4486       return "DW_TAG_constant";
4487     case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4488       return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4489     case DW_TAG_file_type:
4490       return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4491     case DW_TAG_friend:
4492       return "DW_TAG_friend";
4493     case DW_TAG_namelist:
4494       return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4495     case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4496       return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4497     case DW_TAG_namespace:
4498       return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4499     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4500       return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4501     case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4502       return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4503     case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4504       return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4505     case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4506       return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4507     case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4508       return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4509     case DW_TAG_try_block:
4510       return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4511     case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4512       return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4513     case DW_TAG_variable:
4514       return "DW_TAG_variable";
4515     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4516       return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4517     case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4518       return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4519     case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4520       return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4521     case DW_TAG_format_label:
4522       return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4523     case DW_TAG_function_template:
4524       return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4525     case DW_TAG_class_template:
4526       return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4527     case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4528       return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4529     case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4530       return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4531     default:
4532       return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4533     }
4534 }
4535 
4536 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name.  */
4537 
4538 static const char *
dwarf_attr_name(unsigned int attr)4539 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4540 {
4541   switch (attr)
4542     {
4543     case DW_AT_sibling:
4544       return "DW_AT_sibling";
4545     case DW_AT_location:
4546       return "DW_AT_location";
4547     case DW_AT_name:
4548       return "DW_AT_name";
4549     case DW_AT_ordering:
4550       return "DW_AT_ordering";
4551     case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4552       return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4553     case DW_AT_byte_size:
4554       return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4555     case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4556       return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4557     case DW_AT_bit_size:
4558       return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4559     case DW_AT_element_list:
4560       return "DW_AT_element_list";
4561     case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4562       return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4563     case DW_AT_low_pc:
4564       return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4565     case DW_AT_high_pc:
4566       return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4567     case DW_AT_language:
4568       return "DW_AT_language";
4569     case DW_AT_member:
4570       return "DW_AT_member";
4571     case DW_AT_discr:
4572       return "DW_AT_discr";
4573     case DW_AT_discr_value:
4574       return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4575     case DW_AT_visibility:
4576       return "DW_AT_visibility";
4577     case DW_AT_import:
4578       return "DW_AT_import";
4579     case DW_AT_string_length:
4580       return "DW_AT_string_length";
4581     case DW_AT_common_reference:
4582       return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4583     case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4584       return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4585     case DW_AT_const_value:
4586       return "DW_AT_const_value";
4587     case DW_AT_containing_type:
4588       return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4589     case DW_AT_default_value:
4590       return "DW_AT_default_value";
4591     case DW_AT_inline:
4592       return "DW_AT_inline";
4593     case DW_AT_is_optional:
4594       return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4595     case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4596       return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4597     case DW_AT_producer:
4598       return "DW_AT_producer";
4599     case DW_AT_prototyped:
4600       return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4601     case DW_AT_return_addr:
4602       return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4603     case DW_AT_start_scope:
4604       return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4605     case DW_AT_stride_size:
4606       return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4607     case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4608       return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4609     case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4610       return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4611     case DW_AT_accessibility:
4612       return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4613     case DW_AT_address_class:
4614       return "DW_AT_address_class";
4615     case DW_AT_artificial:
4616       return "DW_AT_artificial";
4617     case DW_AT_base_types:
4618       return "DW_AT_base_types";
4619     case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4620       return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4621     case DW_AT_count:
4622       return "DW_AT_count";
4623     case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4624       return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4625     case DW_AT_decl_column:
4626       return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4627     case DW_AT_decl_file:
4628       return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4629     case DW_AT_decl_line:
4630       return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4631     case DW_AT_declaration:
4632       return "DW_AT_declaration";
4633     case DW_AT_discr_list:
4634       return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4635     case DW_AT_encoding:
4636       return "DW_AT_encoding";
4637     case DW_AT_external:
4638       return "DW_AT_external";
4639     case DW_AT_frame_base:
4640       return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4641     case DW_AT_friend:
4642       return "DW_AT_friend";
4643     case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4644       return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4645     case DW_AT_macro_info:
4646       return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4647     case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4648       return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4649     case DW_AT_priority:
4650       return "DW_AT_priority";
4651     case DW_AT_segment:
4652       return "DW_AT_segment";
4653     case DW_AT_specification:
4654       return "DW_AT_specification";
4655     case DW_AT_static_link:
4656       return "DW_AT_static_link";
4657     case DW_AT_type:
4658       return "DW_AT_type";
4659     case DW_AT_use_location:
4660       return "DW_AT_use_location";
4661     case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4662       return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4663     case DW_AT_virtuality:
4664       return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4665     case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4666       return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4667 
4668     case DW_AT_allocated:
4669       return "DW_AT_allocated";
4670     case DW_AT_associated:
4671       return "DW_AT_associated";
4672     case DW_AT_data_location:
4673       return "DW_AT_data_location";
4674     case DW_AT_stride:
4675       return "DW_AT_stride";
4676     case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4677       return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4678     case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4679       return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4680     case DW_AT_extension:
4681       return "DW_AT_extension";
4682     case DW_AT_ranges:
4683       return "DW_AT_ranges";
4684     case DW_AT_trampoline:
4685       return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4686     case DW_AT_call_column:
4687       return "DW_AT_call_column";
4688     case DW_AT_call_file:
4689       return "DW_AT_call_file";
4690     case DW_AT_call_line:
4691       return "DW_AT_call_line";
4692 
4693     case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4694       return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4695     case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4696       return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4697     case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4698       return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4699     case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4700       return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4701     case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4702       return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4703     case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4704       return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4705     case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4706       return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4707     case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4708       return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4709     case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4710       return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4711     case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4712       return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4713     case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4714       return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4715 
4716     case DW_AT_sf_names:
4717       return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4718     case DW_AT_src_info:
4719       return "DW_AT_src_info";
4720     case DW_AT_mac_info:
4721       return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4722     case DW_AT_src_coords:
4723       return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4724     case DW_AT_body_begin:
4725       return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4726     case DW_AT_body_end:
4727       return "DW_AT_body_end";
4728     case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4729       return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4730 
4731     case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4732       return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4733 
4734     default:
4735       return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4736     }
4737 }
4738 
4739 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name.  */
4740 
4741 static const char *
dwarf_form_name(unsigned int form)4742 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4743 {
4744   switch (form)
4745     {
4746     case DW_FORM_addr:
4747       return "DW_FORM_addr";
4748     case DW_FORM_block2:
4749       return "DW_FORM_block2";
4750     case DW_FORM_block4:
4751       return "DW_FORM_block4";
4752     case DW_FORM_data2:
4753       return "DW_FORM_data2";
4754     case DW_FORM_data4:
4755       return "DW_FORM_data4";
4756     case DW_FORM_data8:
4757       return "DW_FORM_data8";
4758     case DW_FORM_string:
4759       return "DW_FORM_string";
4760     case DW_FORM_block:
4761       return "DW_FORM_block";
4762     case DW_FORM_block1:
4763       return "DW_FORM_block1";
4764     case DW_FORM_data1:
4765       return "DW_FORM_data1";
4766     case DW_FORM_flag:
4767       return "DW_FORM_flag";
4768     case DW_FORM_sdata:
4769       return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4770     case DW_FORM_strp:
4771       return "DW_FORM_strp";
4772     case DW_FORM_udata:
4773       return "DW_FORM_udata";
4774     case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4775       return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4776     case DW_FORM_ref1:
4777       return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4778     case DW_FORM_ref2:
4779       return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4780     case DW_FORM_ref4:
4781       return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4782     case DW_FORM_ref8:
4783       return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4784     case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4785       return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4786     case DW_FORM_indirect:
4787       return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4788     default:
4789       return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4790     }
4791 }
4792 
4793 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl.  The decl may be an inlined
4794    instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4795    function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4796    to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4797    given block.  */
4798 
4799 static tree
decl_ultimate_origin(tree decl)4800 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4801 {
4802   if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4803     return NULL_TREE;
4804 
4805   /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4806      nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4807      we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4808   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4809     return NULL_TREE;
4810 
4811   /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4812      most distant ancestor, this should never happen.  */
4813   gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4814 
4815   return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4816 }
4817 
4818 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block.  The block may be an inlined
4819    instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4820    function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4821    to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4822    given block.  */
4823 
4824 static tree
block_ultimate_origin(tree block)4825 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4826 {
4827   tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4828 
4829   /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4830      nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4831      we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4832   if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4833     return NULL_TREE;
4834 
4835   if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4836     return NULL_TREE;
4837   else
4838     {
4839       tree ret_val;
4840       tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4841 
4842       do
4843 	{
4844 	  ret_val = lookahead;
4845 	  lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4846 		       ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4847 	}
4848       while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4849 
4850       /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4851 	 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4852 	 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4853 	 will give us if it has one).  Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4854 	 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4855 	 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins.  */
4856       if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4857 	return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4858 
4859       return ret_val;
4860     }
4861 }
4862 
4863 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any.  In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4864    of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4865    parameter.  */
4866 
4867 static tree
decl_class_context(tree decl)4868 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4869 {
4870   tree context = NULL_TREE;
4871 
4872   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4873     context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4874   else
4875     context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4876       (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4877 
4878   if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4879     context = NULL_TREE;
4880 
4881   return context;
4882 }
4883 
4884 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE.  */
4885 
4886 static inline void
add_dwarf_attr(dw_die_ref die,dw_attr_ref attr)4887 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4888 {
4889   /* Maybe this should be an assert?  */
4890   if (die == NULL)
4891     return;
4892 
4893   if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4894     die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4895   VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4896 }
4897 
4898 static inline enum dw_val_class
AT_class(dw_attr_ref a)4899 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4900 {
4901   return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4902 }
4903 
4904 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE.  */
4905 
4906 static inline void
add_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int flag)4907 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4908 {
4909   dw_attr_node attr;
4910 
4911   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4912   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4913   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4914   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4915 }
4916 
4917 static inline unsigned
AT_flag(dw_attr_ref a)4918 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4919 {
4920   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4921   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4922 }
4923 
4924 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4925 
4926 static inline void
add_AT_int(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)4927 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4928 {
4929   dw_attr_node attr;
4930 
4931   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4932   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4933   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4934   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4935 }
4936 
4937 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_int(dw_attr_ref a)4938 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4939 {
4940   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4941   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4942 }
4943 
4944 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4945 
4946 static inline void
add_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)4947 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4948 		 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4949 {
4950   dw_attr_node attr;
4951 
4952   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4953   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4954   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4955   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4956 }
4957 
4958 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_unsigned(dw_attr_ref a)4959 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4960 {
4961   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4962   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4963 }
4964 
4965 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4966 
4967 static inline void
add_AT_long_long(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int val_hi,long unsigned int val_low)4968 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4969 		  long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4970 {
4971   dw_attr_node attr;
4972 
4973   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4974   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4975   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4976   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4977   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4978 }
4979 
4980 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it.  */
4981 
4982 static inline void
add_AT_vec(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int length,unsigned int elt_size,unsigned char * array)4983 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4984 	    unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4985 {
4986   dw_attr_node attr;
4987 
4988   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4989   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4990   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4991   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4992   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4993   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4994 }
4995 
4996 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash.  */
4997 
4998 static hashval_t
debug_str_do_hash(const void * x)4999 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
5000 {
5001   return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5002 }
5003 
5004 static int
debug_str_eq(const void * x1,const void * x2)5005 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5006 {
5007   return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5008 		 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5009 }
5010 
5011 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE.  */
5012 
5013 static inline void
add_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * str)5014 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5015 {
5016   dw_attr_node attr;
5017   struct indirect_string_node *node;
5018   void **slot;
5019 
5020   if (! debug_str_hash)
5021     debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5022 				      debug_str_eq, NULL);
5023 
5024   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5025 				   htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5026   if (*slot == NULL)
5027     *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5028   node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5029   node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5030   node->refcount++;
5031 
5032   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5033   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5034   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5035   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5036 }
5037 
5038 static inline const char *
AT_string(dw_attr_ref a)5039 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5040 {
5041   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5042   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5043 }
5044 
5045 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5046    or out-of-line in .debug_str section.  */
5047 
5048 static int
AT_string_form(dw_attr_ref a)5049 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5050 {
5051   struct indirect_string_node *node;
5052   unsigned int len;
5053   char label[32];
5054 
5055   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5056 
5057   node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5058   if (node->form)
5059     return node->form;
5060 
5061   len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5062 
5063   /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5064      always better to put it inline.  */
5065   if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5066     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5067 
5068   /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5069      section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5070      single module.  */
5071   if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5072       && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5073     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5074 
5075   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5076   ++dw2_string_counter;
5077   node->label = xstrdup (label);
5078 
5079   return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5080 }
5081 
5082 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5083 
5084 static inline void
add_AT_die_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_die_ref targ_die)5085 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5086 {
5087   dw_attr_node attr;
5088 
5089   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5090   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5091   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5092   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5093   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5094 }
5095 
5096 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5097    pointer from the specification to the definition.  */
5098 
5099 static inline void
add_AT_specification(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref targ_die)5100 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5101 {
5102   add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5103   gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5104   targ_die->die_definition = die;
5105 }
5106 
5107 static inline dw_die_ref
AT_ref(dw_attr_ref a)5108 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5109 {
5110   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5111   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5112 }
5113 
5114 static inline int
AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a)5115 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5116 {
5117   if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5118     return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5119 
5120   return 0;
5121 }
5122 
5123 static inline void
set_AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a,int i)5124 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5125 {
5126   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5127   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5128 }
5129 
5130 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5131 
5132 static inline void
add_AT_fde_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int targ_fde)5133 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5134 {
5135   dw_attr_node attr;
5136 
5137   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5138   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5139   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5140   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5141 }
5142 
5143 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.  */
5144 
5145 static inline void
add_AT_loc(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref loc)5146 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5147 {
5148   dw_attr_node attr;
5149 
5150   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5151   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5152   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5153   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5154 }
5155 
5156 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
AT_loc(dw_attr_ref a)5157 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5158 {
5159   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5160   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5161 }
5162 
5163 static inline void
add_AT_loc_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)5164 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5165 {
5166   dw_attr_node attr;
5167 
5168   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5169   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5170   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5171   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5172   have_location_lists = true;
5173 }
5174 
5175 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
AT_loc_list(dw_attr_ref a)5176 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5177 {
5178   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5179   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5180 }
5181 
5182 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE.  */
5183 
5184 static inline void
add_AT_addr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,rtx addr)5185 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5186 {
5187   dw_attr_node attr;
5188 
5189   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5190   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5191   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5192   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5193 }
5194 
5195 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute.  */
5196 
5197 static inline rtx
AT_addr(dw_attr_ref a)5198 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5199 {
5200   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5201   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5202 }
5203 
5204 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE.  */
5205 
5206 static inline void
add_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,struct dwarf_file_data * fd)5207 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5208 	     struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5209 {
5210   dw_attr_node attr;
5211 
5212   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5213   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5214   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5215   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5216 }
5217 
5218 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute.  */
5219 
5220 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
AT_file(dw_attr_ref a)5221 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5222 {
5223   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5224   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5225 }
5226 
5227 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE.  */
5228 
5229 static inline void
add_AT_lbl_id(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * lbl_id)5230 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5231 {
5232   dw_attr_node attr;
5233 
5234   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5235   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5236   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5237   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5238 }
5239 
5240 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5241    debug_line section.  */
5242 
5243 static inline void
add_AT_lineptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5244 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5245 		const char *label)
5246 {
5247   dw_attr_node attr;
5248 
5249   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5250   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5251   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5252   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5253 }
5254 
5255 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5256    debug_macinfo section.  */
5257 
5258 static inline void
add_AT_macptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5259 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5260 	       const char *label)
5261 {
5262   dw_attr_node attr;
5263 
5264   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5265   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5266   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5267   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5268 }
5269 
5270 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE.  */
5271 
5272 static inline void
add_AT_offset(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)5273 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5274 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5275 {
5276   dw_attr_node attr;
5277 
5278   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5279   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5280   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5281   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5282 }
5283 
5284 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE.  */
5285 
5286 static void
add_AT_range_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int offset)5287 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5288 		   long unsigned int offset)
5289 {
5290   dw_attr_node attr;
5291 
5292   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5293   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5294   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5295   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5296 }
5297 
5298 static inline const char *
AT_lbl(dw_attr_ref a)5299 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5300 {
5301   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5302 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5303 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5304   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5305 }
5306 
5307 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind.  */
5308 
5309 static dw_attr_ref
get_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5310 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5311 {
5312   dw_attr_ref a;
5313   unsigned ix;
5314   dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5315 
5316   if (! die)
5317     return NULL;
5318 
5319   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5320     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5321       return a;
5322     else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5323 	     || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5324       spec = AT_ref (a);
5325 
5326   if (spec)
5327     return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5328 
5329   return NULL;
5330 }
5331 
5332 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5333    DIE.  Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5334    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5335 
5336 static inline const char *
get_AT_low_pc(dw_die_ref die)5337 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5338 {
5339   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5340 
5341   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5342 }
5343 
5344 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5345    DIE.  Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5346    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5347 
5348 static inline const char *
get_AT_hi_pc(dw_die_ref die)5349 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5350 {
5351   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5352 
5353   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5354 }
5355 
5356 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5357    NULL if it is not present.  */
5358 
5359 static inline const char *
get_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5360 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5361 {
5362   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5363 
5364   return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5365 }
5366 
5367 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5368    if it is not present.  */
5369 
5370 static inline int
get_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5371 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5372 {
5373   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5374 
5375   return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5376 }
5377 
5378 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5379    if it is not present.  */
5380 
5381 static inline unsigned
get_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5382 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5383 {
5384   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5385 
5386   return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5387 }
5388 
5389 static inline dw_die_ref
get_AT_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5390 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5391 {
5392   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5393 
5394   return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5395 }
5396 
5397 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
get_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5398 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5399 {
5400   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5401 
5402   return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5403 }
5404 
5405 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++.  */
5406 
5407 static inline bool
is_c_family(void)5408 is_c_family (void)
5409 {
5410   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5411 
5412   return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5413 	  || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5414 	  || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5415 }
5416 
5417 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++.  */
5418 
5419 static inline bool
is_cxx(void)5420 is_cxx (void)
5421 {
5422   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5423 
5424   return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5425 }
5426 
5427 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran.  */
5428 
5429 static inline bool
is_fortran(void)5430 is_fortran (void)
5431 {
5432   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5433 
5434   return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5435 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5436 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5437 }
5438 
5439 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java.  */
5440 
5441 static inline bool
is_java(void)5442 is_java (void)
5443 {
5444   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5445 
5446   return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5447 }
5448 
5449 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada.  */
5450 
5451 static inline bool
is_ada(void)5452 is_ada (void)
5453 {
5454   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5455 
5456   return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5457 }
5458 
5459 /* Remove the specified attribute if present.  */
5460 
5461 static void
remove_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5462 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5463 {
5464   dw_attr_ref a;
5465   unsigned ix;
5466 
5467   if (! die)
5468     return;
5469 
5470   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5471     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5472       {
5473 	if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5474 	  if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5475 	    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5476 
5477 	/* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5478 	   that are needed.  */
5479 	VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5480 	return;
5481       }
5482 }
5483 
5484 /* Remove CHILD from its parent.  PREV must have the property that
5485    PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD.  Does not alter CHILD.  */
5486 
5487 static void
remove_child_with_prev(dw_die_ref child,dw_die_ref prev)5488 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5489 {
5490   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5491   gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5492   if (prev == child)
5493     {
5494       gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5495       prev = NULL;
5496     }
5497   else
5498     prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5499   if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5500     child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5501 }
5502 
5503 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG.  Do nothing if no child
5504    matches TAG.  */
5505 
5506 static void
remove_child_TAG(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_tag tag)5507 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5508 {
5509   dw_die_ref c;
5510 
5511   c = die->die_child;
5512   if (c) do {
5513     dw_die_ref prev = c;
5514     c = c->die_sib;
5515     while (c->die_tag == tag)
5516       {
5517 	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5518 	/* Might have removed every child.  */
5519 	if (c == c->die_sib)
5520 	  return;
5521 	c = c->die_sib;
5522       }
5523   } while (c != die->die_child);
5524 }
5525 
5526 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE.  */
5527 
5528 static void
add_child_die(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref child_die)5529 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5530 {
5531   /* FIXME this should probably be an assert.  */
5532   if (! die || ! child_die)
5533     return;
5534   gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5535 
5536   child_die->die_parent = die;
5537   if (die->die_child)
5538     {
5539       child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5540       die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5541     }
5542   else
5543     child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5544   die->die_child = child_die;
5545 }
5546 
5547 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5548    is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5549    This is done by removing and re-adding it.  */
5550 
5551 static void
splice_child_die(dw_die_ref parent,dw_die_ref child)5552 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5553 {
5554   dw_die_ref p;
5555 
5556   /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5557      specification DIE at toplevel.  */
5558   if (child->die_parent != parent)
5559     {
5560       dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5561 
5562       if (tmp)
5563 	child = tmp;
5564     }
5565 
5566   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5567 	      || (child->die_parent
5568 		  == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5569 
5570   for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5571     if (p->die_sib == child)
5572       {
5573 	remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5574 	break;
5575       }
5576 
5577   add_child_die (parent, child);
5578 }
5579 
5580 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node.  */
5581 
5582 static inline dw_die_ref
new_die(enum dwarf_tag tag_value,dw_die_ref parent_die,tree t)5583 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5584 {
5585   dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5586 
5587   die->die_tag = tag_value;
5588 
5589   if (parent_die != NULL)
5590     add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5591   else
5592     {
5593       limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5594 
5595       limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5596       limbo_node->die = die;
5597       limbo_node->created_for = t;
5598       limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5599       limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5600     }
5601 
5602   return die;
5603 }
5604 
5605 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier.  */
5606 
5607 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_type_die(tree type)5608 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5609 {
5610   return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5611 }
5612 
5613 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier.  */
5614 
5615 static inline void
equate_type_number_to_die(tree type,dw_die_ref type_die)5616 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5617 {
5618   TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5619 }
5620 
5621 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct).  */
5622 
5623 static hashval_t
decl_die_table_hash(const void * x)5624 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5625 {
5626   return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5627 }
5628 
5629 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y.  */
5630 
5631 static int
decl_die_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5632 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5633 {
5634   return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5635 }
5636 
5637 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration.  */
5638 
5639 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_decl_die(tree decl)5640 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5641 {
5642   return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5643 }
5644 
5645 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list).  */
5646 
5647 static hashval_t
decl_loc_table_hash(const void * x)5648 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5649 {
5650   return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5651 }
5652 
5653 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5654    UID of decl *Y.  */
5655 
5656 static int
decl_loc_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5657 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5658 {
5659   return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5660 }
5661 
5662 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration.  */
5663 
5664 static inline var_loc_list *
lookup_decl_loc(tree decl)5665 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5666 {
5667   return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5668 }
5669 
5670 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration.  */
5671 
5672 static void
equate_decl_number_to_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref decl_die)5673 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5674 {
5675   unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5676   void **slot;
5677 
5678   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5679   *slot = decl_die;
5680   decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5681 }
5682 
5683 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL.  */
5684 
5685 static void
add_var_loc_to_decl(tree decl,struct var_loc_node * loc)5686 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5687 {
5688   unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5689   var_loc_list *temp;
5690   void **slot;
5691 
5692   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5693   if (*slot == NULL)
5694     {
5695       temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5696       temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5697       *slot = temp;
5698     }
5699   else
5700     temp = *slot;
5701 
5702   if (temp->last)
5703     {
5704       /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5705 	 we have nothing to do.  */
5706       if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5707 			NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5708 	{
5709 	  /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST.  */
5710 	  temp->last->next = loc;
5711 	  temp->last = loc;
5712 	}
5713     }
5714   /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list.  */
5715   else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5716     {
5717       temp->first = loc;
5718       temp->last = loc;
5719     }
5720 }
5721 
5722 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5723    output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5724    the DIE internal representation.  */
5725 static int print_indent;
5726 
5727 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent.  */
5728 
5729 static inline void
print_spaces(FILE * outfile)5730 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5731 {
5732   fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5733 }
5734 
5735 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5736    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5737 
5738 static void
print_die(dw_die_ref die,FILE * outfile)5739 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5740 {
5741   dw_attr_ref a;
5742   dw_die_ref c;
5743   unsigned ix;
5744 
5745   print_spaces (outfile);
5746   fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
5747 	   die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5748   print_spaces (outfile);
5749   fprintf (outfile, "  abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5750   fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
5751 
5752   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5753     {
5754       print_spaces (outfile);
5755       fprintf (outfile, "  %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5756 
5757       switch (AT_class (a))
5758 	{
5759 	case dw_val_class_addr:
5760 	  fprintf (outfile, "address");
5761 	  break;
5762 	case dw_val_class_offset:
5763 	  fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5764 	  break;
5765 	case dw_val_class_loc:
5766 	  fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5767 	  break;
5768 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5769 	  fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5770 		   AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5771 	  break;
5772 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
5773 	  fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5774 	  break;
5775 	case dw_val_class_const:
5776 	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5777 	  break;
5778 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5779 	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5780 	  break;
5781 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
5782 	  fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5783 		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5784 		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5785 	  break;
5786 	case dw_val_class_vec:
5787 	  fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5788 	  break;
5789 	case dw_val_class_flag:
5790 	  fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5791 	  break;
5792 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5793 	  if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5794 	    {
5795 	      if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5796 		fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5797 	      else
5798 		fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5799 	    }
5800 	  else
5801 	    fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5802 	  break;
5803 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5804 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5805 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
5806 	  fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5807 	  break;
5808 	case dw_val_class_str:
5809 	  if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5810 	    fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5811 	  else
5812 	    fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5813 	  break;
5814 	case dw_val_class_file:
5815 	  fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5816 		   AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5817 	  break;
5818 	default:
5819 	  break;
5820 	}
5821 
5822       fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5823     }
5824 
5825   if (die->die_child != NULL)
5826     {
5827       print_indent += 4;
5828       FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5829       print_indent -= 4;
5830     }
5831   if (print_indent == 0)
5832     fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5833 }
5834 
5835 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5836    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5837 
5838 static void
print_dwarf_line_table(FILE * outfile)5839 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5840 {
5841   unsigned i;
5842   dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5843 
5844   fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5845   for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5846     {
5847       line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5848       fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
5849 	       line_info->dw_file_num,
5850 	       line_info->dw_line_num);
5851     }
5852 
5853   fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5854 }
5855 
5856 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE.  */
5857 
5858 void
debug_dwarf_die(dw_die_ref die)5859 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5860 {
5861   print_die (die, stderr);
5862 }
5863 
5864 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5865    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5866 
5867 void
debug_dwarf(void)5868 debug_dwarf (void)
5869 {
5870   print_indent = 0;
5871   print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5872   if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5873     print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5874 }
5875 
5876 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file.  OLD_UNIT is the CU
5877    for the enclosing include file, if any.  BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5878    DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file.  */
5879 
5880 static dw_die_ref
push_new_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit,dw_die_ref bincl_die)5881 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5882 {
5883   const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5884   dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5885 
5886   new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5887   return new_unit;
5888 }
5889 
5890 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one.  */
5891 
5892 static dw_die_ref
pop_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit)5893 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5894 {
5895   dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5896 
5897   old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5898   return new_unit;
5899 }
5900 
5901 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5902 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5903 
5904 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression.  */
5905 
5906 static inline void
loc_checksum(dw_loc_descr_ref loc,struct md5_ctx * ctx)5907 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5908 {
5909   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5910   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5911   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5912 }
5913 
5914 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute.  */
5915 
5916 static void
attr_checksum(dw_attr_ref at,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5917 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5918 {
5919   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5920   rtx r;
5921 
5922   CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5923 
5924   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5925      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters.  */
5926   if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5927     return;
5928 
5929   switch (AT_class (at))
5930     {
5931     case dw_val_class_const:
5932       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5933       break;
5934     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5935       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5936       break;
5937     case dw_val_class_long_long:
5938       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5939       break;
5940     case dw_val_class_vec:
5941       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5942       break;
5943     case dw_val_class_flag:
5944       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5945       break;
5946     case dw_val_class_str:
5947       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5948       break;
5949 
5950     case dw_val_class_addr:
5951       r = AT_addr (at);
5952       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5953       CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5954       break;
5955 
5956     case dw_val_class_offset:
5957       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5958       break;
5959 
5960     case dw_val_class_loc:
5961       for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5962 	loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5963       break;
5964 
5965     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5966       die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5967       break;
5968 
5969     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5970     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5971     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5972     case dw_val_class_macptr:
5973       break;
5974 
5975     case dw_val_class_file:
5976       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5977       break;
5978 
5979     default:
5980       break;
5981     }
5982 }
5983 
5984 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE.  */
5985 
5986 static void
die_checksum(dw_die_ref die,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5987 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5988 {
5989   dw_die_ref c;
5990   dw_attr_ref a;
5991   unsigned ix;
5992 
5993   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
5994   if (die->die_mark)
5995     {
5996       CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5997       return;
5998     }
5999   die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6000 
6001   CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6002 
6003   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6004     attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6005 
6006   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6007 }
6008 
6009 #undef CHECKSUM
6010 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6011 
6012 /* Do the location expressions look same?  */
6013 static inline int
same_loc_p(dw_loc_descr_ref loc1,dw_loc_descr_ref loc2,int * mark)6014 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6015 {
6016   return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6017 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6018 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6019 }
6020 
6021 /* Do the values look the same?  */
6022 static int
same_dw_val_p(dw_val_node * v1,dw_val_node * v2,int * mark)6023 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6024 {
6025   dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6026   rtx r1, r2;
6027 
6028   if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6029     return 0;
6030 
6031   switch (v1->val_class)
6032     {
6033     case dw_val_class_const:
6034       return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6035     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6036       return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6037     case dw_val_class_long_long:
6038       return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6039 	     && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6040     case dw_val_class_vec:
6041       if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6042 	  || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6043 	return 0;
6044       if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6045 		  v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6046 	return 0;
6047       return 1;
6048     case dw_val_class_flag:
6049       return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6050     case dw_val_class_str:
6051       return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6052 
6053     case dw_val_class_addr:
6054       r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6055       r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6056       if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6057 	return 0;
6058       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6059       return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6060 
6061     case dw_val_class_offset:
6062       return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6063 
6064     case dw_val_class_loc:
6065       for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6066 	   loc1 && loc2;
6067 	   loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6068 	if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6069 	  return 0;
6070       return !loc1 && !loc2;
6071 
6072     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6073       return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6074 
6075     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6076     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6077     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6078     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6079       return 1;
6080 
6081     case dw_val_class_file:
6082       return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6083 
6084     default:
6085       return 1;
6086     }
6087 }
6088 
6089 /* Do the attributes look the same?  */
6090 
6091 static int
same_attr_p(dw_attr_ref at1,dw_attr_ref at2,int * mark)6092 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6093 {
6094   if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6095     return 0;
6096 
6097   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6098      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6099   if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6100     return 1;
6101 
6102   return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6103 }
6104 
6105 /* Do the dies look the same?  */
6106 
6107 static int
same_die_p(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2,int * mark)6108 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6109 {
6110   dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6111   dw_attr_ref a1;
6112   unsigned ix;
6113 
6114   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
6115   if (die1->die_mark)
6116     return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6117   die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6118 
6119   if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6120     return 0;
6121 
6122   if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6123       != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6124     return 0;
6125 
6126   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6127     if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6128       return 0;
6129 
6130   c1 = die1->die_child;
6131   c2 = die2->die_child;
6132   if (! c1)
6133     {
6134       if (c2)
6135 	return 0;
6136     }
6137   else
6138     for (;;)
6139       {
6140 	if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6141 	  return 0;
6142 	c1 = c1->die_sib;
6143 	c2 = c2->die_sib;
6144 	if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6145 	  {
6146 	    if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6147 	      break;
6148 	    else
6149 	      return 0;
6150 	  }
6151     }
6152 
6153   return 1;
6154 }
6155 
6156 /* Do the dies look the same?  Wrapper around same_die_p.  */
6157 
6158 static int
same_die_p_wrap(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2)6159 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6160 {
6161   int mark = 0;
6162   int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6163 
6164   unmark_all_dies (die1);
6165   unmark_all_dies (die2);
6166 
6167   return ret;
6168 }
6169 
6170 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6171    info section.  */
6172 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6173 
6174 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU.  */
6175 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6176 
6177 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6178    children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly.  */
6179 
6180 static void
compute_section_prefix(dw_die_ref unit_die)6181 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6182 {
6183   const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6184   const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6185   char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6186   char *p;
6187   int i, mark;
6188   unsigned char checksum[16];
6189   struct md5_ctx ctx;
6190 
6191   /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6192      the name filename of the unit.  */
6193 
6194   md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6195   mark = 0;
6196   die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6197   unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6198   md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6199 
6200   sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6201   clean_symbol_name (name);
6202 
6203   p = name + strlen (name);
6204   for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6205     {
6206       sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6207       p += 2;
6208     }
6209 
6210   comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6211   comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6212 }
6213 
6214 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P.  */
6215 
6216 static int
is_type_die(dw_die_ref die)6217 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6218 {
6219   switch (die->die_tag)
6220     {
6221     case DW_TAG_array_type:
6222     case DW_TAG_class_type:
6223     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6224     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6225     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6226     case DW_TAG_string_type:
6227     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6228     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6229     case DW_TAG_union_type:
6230     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6231     case DW_TAG_set_type:
6232     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6233     case DW_TAG_base_type:
6234     case DW_TAG_const_type:
6235     case DW_TAG_file_type:
6236     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6237     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6238     case DW_TAG_typedef:
6239       return 1;
6240     default:
6241       return 0;
6242     }
6243 }
6244 
6245 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6246    Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6247    compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6248    compilations (functions).  */
6249 
6250 static int
is_comdat_die(dw_die_ref c)6251 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6252 {
6253   /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6254      we do for stabs.  The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6255      objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6256      put the base types in a different comdat).  jason 8/28/00 */
6257 
6258   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6259     return 0;
6260 
6261   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6262       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6263       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6264       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6265     {
6266       dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6267 
6268       return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6269     }
6270 
6271   return is_type_die (c);
6272 }
6273 
6274 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6275    compilation unit.  */
6276 
6277 static int
is_symbol_die(dw_die_ref c)6278 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6279 {
6280   return (is_type_die (c)
6281 	  || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6282 	      && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6283 	  || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6284 }
6285 
6286 static char *
gen_internal_sym(const char * prefix)6287 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6288 {
6289   char buf[256];
6290 
6291   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6292   return xstrdup (buf);
6293 }
6294 
6295 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE.  */
6296 
6297 static void
assign_symbol_names(dw_die_ref die)6298 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6299 {
6300   dw_die_ref c;
6301 
6302   if (is_symbol_die (die))
6303     {
6304       if (comdat_symbol_id)
6305 	{
6306 	  char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6307 
6308 	  sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6309 		   comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6310 	  die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6311 	}
6312       else
6313 	die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6314     }
6315 
6316   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6317 }
6318 
6319 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6320 {
6321   dw_die_ref cu;
6322   unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6323   struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6324 };
6325 
6326 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs.  */
6327 static hashval_t
htab_cu_hash(const void * of)6328 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6329 {
6330   const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6331 
6332   return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6333 }
6334 
6335 static int
htab_cu_eq(const void * of1,const void * of2)6336 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6337 {
6338   const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6339   const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6340 
6341   return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6342 }
6343 
6344 static void
htab_cu_del(void * what)6345 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6346 {
6347   struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6348 
6349   while (entry)
6350     {
6351       next = entry->next;
6352       free (entry);
6353       entry = next;
6354     }
6355 }
6356 
6357 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6358    accordingly.  */
6359 static int
check_duplicate_cu(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int * sym_num)6360 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6361 {
6362   struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6363   struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6364 
6365   dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6366 
6367   slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6368     htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6369 	INSERT);
6370   entry = *slot;
6371 
6372   for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6373     {
6374       if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6375 	break;
6376     }
6377 
6378   if (entry)
6379     {
6380       *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6381       return 1;
6382     }
6383 
6384   entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6385   entry->cu = cu;
6386   entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6387   entry->next = *slot;
6388   *slot = entry;
6389 
6390   return 0;
6391 }
6392 
6393 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE.  */
6394 static void
record_comdat_symbol_number(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int sym_num)6395 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6396 {
6397   struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6398 
6399   slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6400     htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6401 	NO_INSERT);
6402   entry = *slot;
6403 
6404   entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6405 }
6406 
6407 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6408    additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6409    bracketed by BINCL/EINCL.  */
6410 
6411 static void
break_out_includes(dw_die_ref die)6412 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6413 {
6414   dw_die_ref c;
6415   dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6416   limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6417   htab_t cu_hash_table;
6418 
6419   c = die->die_child;
6420   if (c) do {
6421     dw_die_ref prev = c;
6422     c = c->die_sib;
6423     while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6424 	   || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6425       {
6426 	dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6427 
6428 	/* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one.  */
6429 	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6430 
6431 	if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6432 	  unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6433 	else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6434 	  unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6435 	else
6436 	  add_child_die (unit, c);
6437 	c = next;
6438 	if (c == die->die_child)
6439 	  break;
6440       }
6441   } while (c != die->die_child);
6442 
6443 #if 0
6444   /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6445      to make sure that we leave every include file we enter.  */
6446   gcc_assert (!unit);
6447 #endif
6448 
6449   assign_symbol_names (die);
6450   cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6451   for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6452        node;
6453        node = node->next)
6454     {
6455       int is_dupl;
6456 
6457       compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6458       is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6459 			&comdat_symbol_number);
6460       assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6461       if (is_dupl)
6462 	*pnode = node->next;
6463       else
6464 	{
6465 	  pnode = &node->next;
6466 	  record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6467 		comdat_symbol_number);
6468 	}
6469     }
6470   htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6471 }
6472 
6473 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6474    effect of speeding up access to siblings.  To save some space,
6475    avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children.  */
6476 
6477 static void
add_sibling_attributes(dw_die_ref die)6478 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6479 {
6480   dw_die_ref c;
6481 
6482   if (! die->die_child)
6483     return;
6484 
6485   if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6486     add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6487 
6488   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6489 }
6490 
6491 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children.  */
6492 
6493 static void
output_location_lists(dw_die_ref die)6494 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6495 {
6496   dw_die_ref c;
6497   dw_attr_ref a;
6498   unsigned ix;
6499 
6500   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6501     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6502       output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6503 
6504   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6505 }
6506 
6507 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6508    abbreviation table.  This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6509    a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry.  The children of each
6510    die are visited recursively.  */
6511 
6512 static void
build_abbrev_table(dw_die_ref die)6513 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6514 {
6515   unsigned long abbrev_id;
6516   unsigned int n_alloc;
6517   dw_die_ref c;
6518   dw_attr_ref a;
6519   unsigned ix;
6520 
6521   /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6522      DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked).  */
6523   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6524     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6525 	&& AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6526       {
6527 	gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6528 
6529 	set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6530       }
6531 
6532   for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6533     {
6534       dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6535       dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6536       unsigned ix;
6537       bool ok = true;
6538 
6539       if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6540 	continue;
6541       if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6542 	continue;
6543 
6544       if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6545 	  != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6546 	continue;
6547 
6548       for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6549 	{
6550 	  abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6551 	  if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6552 	      || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6553 	    {
6554 	      ok = false;
6555 	      break;
6556 	    }
6557 	}
6558       if (ok)
6559 	break;
6560     }
6561 
6562   if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6563     {
6564       if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6565 	{
6566 	  n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6567 	  abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6568 					  sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6569 
6570 	  memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6571 		 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6572 	  abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6573 	}
6574 
6575       ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6576       abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6577     }
6578 
6579   die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6580   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6581 }
6582 
6583 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE.  */
6584 
6585 static int
constant_size(long unsigned int value)6586 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6587 {
6588   int log;
6589 
6590   if (value == 0)
6591     log = 0;
6592   else
6593     log = floor_log2 (value);
6594 
6595   log = log / 8;
6596   log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6597 
6598   return log;
6599 }
6600 
6601 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6602    .debug_info section.  */
6603 
6604 static unsigned long
size_of_die(dw_die_ref die)6605 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6606 {
6607   unsigned long size = 0;
6608   dw_attr_ref a;
6609   unsigned ix;
6610 
6611   size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6612   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6613     {
6614       switch (AT_class (a))
6615 	{
6616 	case dw_val_class_addr:
6617 	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6618 	  break;
6619 	case dw_val_class_offset:
6620 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6621 	  break;
6622 	case dw_val_class_loc:
6623 	  {
6624 	    unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6625 
6626 	    /* Block length.  */
6627 	    size += constant_size (lsize);
6628 	    size += lsize;
6629 	  }
6630 	  break;
6631 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6632 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6633 	  break;
6634 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
6635 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6636 	  break;
6637 	case dw_val_class_const:
6638 	  size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6639 	  break;
6640 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6641 	  size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6642 	  break;
6643 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
6644 	  size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6645 	  break;
6646 	case dw_val_class_vec:
6647 	  size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6648 		       * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6649 	  break;
6650 	case dw_val_class_flag:
6651 	  size += 1;
6652 	  break;
6653 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6654 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
6655 	    size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6656 	  else
6657 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6658 	  break;
6659 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6660 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6661 	  break;
6662 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6663 	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6664 	  break;
6665 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6666 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
6667 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6668 	  break;
6669 	case dw_val_class_str:
6670 	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6671 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6672 	  else
6673 	    size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6674 	  break;
6675 	case dw_val_class_file:
6676 	  size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6677 	  break;
6678 	default:
6679 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6680 	}
6681     }
6682 
6683   return size;
6684 }
6685 
6686 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE.  Visits the
6687    DIE's children recursively.  Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6688    each time through.  Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6689    die_offset field in each DIE.  */
6690 
6691 static void
calc_die_sizes(dw_die_ref die)6692 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6693 {
6694   dw_die_ref c;
6695 
6696   die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6697   next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6698 
6699   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6700 
6701   if (die->die_child != NULL)
6702     /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists.  */
6703     next_die_offset += 1;
6704 }
6705 
6706 /* Set the marks for a die and its children.  We do this so
6707    that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6708    DIEs in the same CU will be marked.  We used to clear out the offset
6709    and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems.  */
6710 
6711 static void
mark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6712 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6713 {
6714   dw_die_ref c;
6715 
6716   gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6717 
6718   die->die_mark = 1;
6719   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6720 }
6721 
6722 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.  */
6723 
6724 static void
unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6725 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6726 {
6727   dw_die_ref c;
6728 
6729   gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6730 
6731   die->die_mark = 0;
6732   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6733 }
6734 
6735 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies.  */
6736 
6737 static void
unmark_all_dies(dw_die_ref die)6738 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6739 {
6740   dw_die_ref c;
6741   dw_attr_ref a;
6742   unsigned ix;
6743 
6744   if (!die->die_mark)
6745     return;
6746   die->die_mark = 0;
6747 
6748   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6749 
6750   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6751     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6752       unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6753 }
6754 
6755 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6756    generated for the compilation unit.  */
6757 
6758 static unsigned long
size_of_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)6759 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
6760 {
6761   unsigned long size;
6762   unsigned i;
6763   pubname_ref p;
6764 
6765   size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6766   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
6767     if (names != pubtype_table
6768 	|| p->die->die_offset != 0
6769 	|| !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
6770       size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
6771 
6772   size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6773   return size;
6774 }
6775 
6776 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section.  */
6777 
6778 static unsigned long
size_of_aranges(void)6779 size_of_aranges (void)
6780 {
6781   unsigned long size;
6782 
6783   size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6784 
6785   /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit.  */
6786   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6787   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6788 
6789   /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table.  */
6790   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6791   return size;
6792 }
6793 
6794 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6795 
6796 static enum dwarf_form
value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6797 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6798 {
6799   switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6800     {
6801     case dw_val_class_addr:
6802       return DW_FORM_addr;
6803     case dw_val_class_range_list:
6804     case dw_val_class_offset:
6805     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6806       switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6807 	{
6808 	case 4:
6809 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6810 	case 8:
6811 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6812 	default:
6813 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6814 	}
6815     case dw_val_class_loc:
6816       switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6817 	{
6818 	case 1:
6819 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
6820 	case 2:
6821 	  return DW_FORM_block2;
6822 	default:
6823 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6824 	}
6825     case dw_val_class_const:
6826       return DW_FORM_sdata;
6827     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6828       switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6829 	{
6830 	case 1:
6831 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6832 	case 2:
6833 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6834 	case 4:
6835 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6836 	case 8:
6837 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6838 	default:
6839 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6840 	}
6841     case dw_val_class_long_long:
6842       return DW_FORM_block1;
6843     case dw_val_class_vec:
6844       return DW_FORM_block1;
6845     case dw_val_class_flag:
6846       return DW_FORM_flag;
6847     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6848       if (AT_ref_external (a))
6849 	return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6850       else
6851 	return DW_FORM_ref;
6852     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6853       return DW_FORM_data;
6854     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6855       return DW_FORM_addr;
6856     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6857     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6858       return DW_FORM_data;
6859     case dw_val_class_str:
6860       return AT_string_form (a);
6861     case dw_val_class_file:
6862       switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
6863 	{
6864 	case 1:
6865 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6866 	case 2:
6867 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6868 	case 4:
6869 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6870 	default:
6871 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6872 	}
6873 
6874     default:
6875       gcc_unreachable ();
6876     }
6877 }
6878 
6879 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6880 
6881 static void
output_value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6882 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6883 {
6884   enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6885 
6886   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6887 }
6888 
6889 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6890    table.  */
6891 
6892 static void
output_abbrev_section(void)6893 output_abbrev_section (void)
6894 {
6895   unsigned long abbrev_id;
6896 
6897   for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6898     {
6899       dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6900       unsigned ix;
6901       dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6902 
6903       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6904       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6905 				   dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6906 
6907       if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6908 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6909       else
6910 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6911 
6912       for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6913 	   ix++)
6914 	{
6915 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6916 				       dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6917 	  output_value_format (a_attr);
6918 	}
6919 
6920       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6921       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6922     }
6923 
6924   /* Terminate the table.  */
6925   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6926 }
6927 
6928 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU.  */
6929 
6930 static inline void
output_die_symbol(dw_die_ref die)6931 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6932 {
6933   char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6934 
6935   if (sym == 0)
6936     return;
6937 
6938   if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6939     /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6940        .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6941        will break.  */
6942     targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6943 
6944   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6945 }
6946 
6947 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6948    expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6949    this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only.  */
6950 
6951 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
new_loc_list(dw_loc_descr_ref expr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section,unsigned int gensym)6952 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6953 	      const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6954 {
6955   dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6956 
6957   retlist->begin = begin;
6958   retlist->end = end;
6959   retlist->expr = expr;
6960   retlist->section = section;
6961   if (gensym)
6962     retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6963 
6964   return retlist;
6965 }
6966 
6967 /* Add a location description expression to a location list.  */
6968 
6969 static inline void
add_loc_descr_to_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section)6970 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6971 			   const char *begin, const char *end,
6972 			   const char *section)
6973 {
6974   dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6975 
6976   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
6977   for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6978     ;
6979 
6980   /* Add a new location list node to the list.  */
6981   *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6982 }
6983 
6984 static void
dwarf2out_switch_text_section(void)6985 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6986 {
6987   dw_fde_ref fde;
6988 
6989   gcc_assert (cfun);
6990 
6991   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6992   fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6993   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6994   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
6995   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
6996   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
6997   have_multiple_function_sections = true;
6998 
6999   /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
7000      don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections.  */
7001   fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
7002 }
7003 
7004 /* Output the location list given to us.  */
7005 
7006 static void
output_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref list_head)7007 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7008 {
7009   dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7010 
7011   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7012 
7013   /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression.  */
7014   for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7015     {
7016       unsigned long size;
7017       if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7018 	{
7019 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7020 				"Location list begin address (%s)",
7021 				list_head->ll_symbol);
7022 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7023 				"Location list end address (%s)",
7024 				list_head->ll_symbol);
7025 	}
7026       else
7027 	{
7028 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7029 			       "Location list begin address (%s)",
7030 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7031 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7032 			       "Location list end address (%s)",
7033 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7034 	}
7035       size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7036 
7037       /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7038       gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7039       dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7040 
7041       output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7042     }
7043 
7044   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7045 		       "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7046 		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7047   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7048 		       "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7049 		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7050 }
7051 
7052 /* Output the DIE and its attributes.  Called recursively to generate
7053    the definitions of each child DIE.  */
7054 
7055 static void
output_die(dw_die_ref die)7056 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7057 {
7058   dw_attr_ref a;
7059   dw_die_ref c;
7060   unsigned long size;
7061   unsigned ix;
7062 
7063   /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7064      them to point to.  */
7065   if (die->die_symbol)
7066     output_die_symbol (die);
7067 
7068   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7069 			       (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
7070 			       dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7071 
7072   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7073     {
7074       const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7075 
7076       switch (AT_class (a))
7077 	{
7078 	case dw_val_class_addr:
7079 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7080 	  break;
7081 
7082 	case dw_val_class_offset:
7083 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7084 			       "%s", name);
7085 	  break;
7086 
7087 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
7088 	  {
7089 	    char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7090 
7091 	    sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7092 		     a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7093 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7094 				   debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7095 	    *p = '\0';
7096 	  }
7097 	  break;
7098 
7099 	case dw_val_class_loc:
7100 	  size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7101 
7102 	  /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7103 	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7104 
7105 	  output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7106 	  break;
7107 
7108 	case dw_val_class_const:
7109 	  /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7110 	     used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7111 	     extend.  Gdb 5.x does sign extend.  */
7112 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7113 	  break;
7114 
7115 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7116 	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7117 			       AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7118 	  break;
7119 
7120 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
7121 	  {
7122 	    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7123 
7124 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7125 				 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7126 				 "%s", name);
7127 
7128 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7129 	      {
7130 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7131 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7132 	      }
7133 	    else
7134 	      {
7135 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7136 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7137 	      }
7138 
7139 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7140 				 first, "long long constant");
7141 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7142 				 second, NULL);
7143 	  }
7144 	  break;
7145 
7146 	case dw_val_class_vec:
7147 	  {
7148 	    unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7149 	    unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7150 	    unsigned int i;
7151 	    unsigned char *p;
7152 
7153 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7154 	    if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7155 	      {
7156 		elt_size /= 2;
7157 		len *= 2;
7158 	      }
7159 	    for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7160 		 i < len;
7161 		 i++, p += elt_size)
7162 	      dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7163 				   "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7164 	    break;
7165 	  }
7166 
7167 	case dw_val_class_flag:
7168 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7169 	  break;
7170 
7171 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7172 	  {
7173 	    char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7174 
7175 	    gcc_assert (sym);
7176 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7177 				   "%s", name);
7178 	  }
7179 	  break;
7180 
7181 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7182 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
7183 	    {
7184 	      char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7185 
7186 	      gcc_assert (sym);
7187 	      dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7188 				     "%s", name);
7189 	    }
7190 	  else
7191 	    {
7192 	      gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7193 	      dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7194 				   "%s", name);
7195 	    }
7196 	  break;
7197 
7198 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7199 	  {
7200 	    char l1[20];
7201 
7202 	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7203 					 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7204 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7205 				   "%s", name);
7206 	  }
7207 	  break;
7208 
7209 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7210 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7211 	  break;
7212 
7213 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7214 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7215 				 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7216 	  break;
7217 
7218 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
7219 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7220 				 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7221 	  break;
7222 
7223 	case dw_val_class_str:
7224 	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7225 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7226 				   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7227 				   debug_str_section,
7228 				   "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7229 	  else
7230 	    dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7231 	  break;
7232 
7233 	case dw_val_class_file:
7234 	  {
7235 	    int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7236 
7237 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7238 				 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7239 	    break;
7240 	  }
7241 
7242 	default:
7243 	  gcc_unreachable ();
7244 	}
7245     }
7246 
7247   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7248 
7249   /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list.  */
7250   if (die->die_child != NULL)
7251     dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7252 			 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
7253 }
7254 
7255 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7256    .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions.  */
7257 
7258 static void
output_compilation_unit_header(void)7259 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7260 {
7261   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7262     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7263       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7264   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7265                        next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7266 		       "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7267   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7268   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7269 			 debug_abbrev_section,
7270 			 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7271   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7272 }
7273 
7274 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children.  */
7275 
7276 static void
output_comp_unit(dw_die_ref die,int output_if_empty)7277 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7278 {
7279   const char *secname;
7280   char *oldsym, *tmp;
7281 
7282   /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones.  */
7283   if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7284     return;
7285 
7286   /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7287      about the compilation unit.  Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7288      will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7289      will then complain when examining the file.  First mark all the DIEs in
7290      this CU so we know which get local refs.  */
7291   mark_dies (die);
7292 
7293   build_abbrev_table (die);
7294 
7295   /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets.  */
7296   next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7297   calc_die_sizes (die);
7298 
7299   oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7300   if (oldsym)
7301     {
7302       tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7303 
7304       sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7305       secname = tmp;
7306       die->die_symbol = NULL;
7307       switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7308     }
7309   else
7310     switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7311 
7312   /* Output debugging information.  */
7313   output_compilation_unit_header ();
7314   output_die (die);
7315 
7316   /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7317      output_pubnames.  */
7318   if (oldsym)
7319     {
7320       unmark_dies (die);
7321       die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7322     }
7323 }
7324 
7325 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl.  */
7326 
7327 static const char *
dwarf2_name(tree decl,int scope)7328 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7329 {
7330   return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7331 }
7332 
7333 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate.  */
7334 
7335 static void
add_pubname(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7336 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7337 {
7338   pubname_entry e;
7339 
7340   if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7341     return;
7342 
7343   e.die = die;
7344   e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7345   VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
7346 }
7347 
7348 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate.  */
7349 
7350 static void
add_pubtype(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7351 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7352 {
7353   pubname_entry e;
7354 
7355   e.name = NULL;
7356   if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7357        || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
7358       && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
7359     {
7360       e.die = die;
7361       if (TYPE_P (decl))
7362 	{
7363 	  if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
7364 	    {
7365 	      if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
7366 		e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7367 				                              (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
7368 	      else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
7369 		       && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
7370 		e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7371 				                  (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl))));
7372              else
7373 	       e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
7374 	    }
7375 	}
7376       else
7377 	e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7378 
7379       /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7380 	 it to the table.  */
7381       if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
7382 	VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
7383     }
7384 }
7385 
7386 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7387    visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions.  */
7388 
7389 static void
output_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)7390 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7391 {
7392   unsigned i;
7393   unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
7394   pubname_ref pub;
7395 
7396   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7397     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7398       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7399   if (names == pubname_table)
7400     dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7401 			 "Length of Public Names Info");
7402   else
7403     dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7404 			 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7405   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7406   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7407 			 debug_info_section,
7408 			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7409   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7410 		       "Compilation Unit Length");
7411 
7412   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
7413     {
7414       /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7415       if (names == pubname_table)
7416 	gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7417 
7418       if (names != pubtype_table
7419 	  || pub->die->die_offset != 0
7420 	  || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7421 	{
7422 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7423 			       "DIE offset");
7424 
7425 	  dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7426 	}
7427     }
7428 
7429   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7430 }
7431 
7432 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate.  */
7433 
7434 static void
add_arange(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7435 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7436 {
7437   if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7438     return;
7439 
7440   if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7441     {
7442       arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7443       arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7444 				  (arange_table_allocated
7445 				   * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7446       memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7447 	      ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7448     }
7449 
7450   arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7451 }
7452 
7453 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7454    Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7455    text section generated for this compilation unit.  */
7456 
7457 static void
output_aranges(void)7458 output_aranges (void)
7459 {
7460   unsigned i;
7461   unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7462 
7463   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7464     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7465       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7466   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7467 		       "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7468   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7469   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7470 			 debug_info_section,
7471 			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7472   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7473   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7474 
7475   /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here.  */
7476   if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7477     {
7478       /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7479 	 pointer size.  */
7480       dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7481 			   2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7482       for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7483 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7484     }
7485 
7486   dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7487   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7488 			text_section_label, "Length");
7489   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7490     {
7491       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7492 			   "Address");
7493       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7494 			    cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7495     }
7496 
7497   for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7498     {
7499       dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7500 
7501       /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7502       gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7503 
7504       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7505 	{
7506 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7507 			       "Address");
7508 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7509 				get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7510 	}
7511       else
7512 	{
7513 	  /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7514 	     Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7515 	     aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99).  */
7516 	  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7517 	  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7518 
7519 	  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7520 
7521 	  loc = AT_loc (a);
7522 	  gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7523 
7524 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7525 				   loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7526 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7527 			       get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7528 			       "Length");
7529 	}
7530     }
7531 
7532   /* Output the terminator words.  */
7533   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7534   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7535 }
7536 
7537 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges.  Return the offset at which it
7538    was placed.  */
7539 
7540 static unsigned int
add_ranges(tree block)7541 add_ranges (tree block)
7542 {
7543   unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7544 
7545   if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7546     {
7547       ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7548       ranges_table
7549 	= ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7550 				      * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7551       memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7552 	      RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7553     }
7554 
7555   ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7556   ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7557 
7558   return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7559 }
7560 
7561 static void
output_ranges(void)7562 output_ranges (void)
7563 {
7564   unsigned i;
7565   static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7566   const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7567 
7568   for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7569     {
7570       int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7571 
7572       if (block_num)
7573 	{
7574 	  char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7575 	  char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7576 
7577 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7578 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7579 
7580 	  /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7581 	     unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7582 	     base of the text section.  */
7583 	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7584 	    {
7585 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7586 				    text_section_label,
7587 				    fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7588 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7589 				    text_section_label, NULL);
7590 	    }
7591 
7592 	  /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7593 	     compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7594 	     use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7595 	     target supports cross-section arithmetic.  */
7596 	  else
7597 	    {
7598 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7599 				   fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7600 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7601 	    }
7602 
7603 	  fmt = NULL;
7604 	}
7605       else
7606 	{
7607 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7608 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7609 	  fmt = start_fmt;
7610 	}
7611     }
7612 }
7613 
7614 /* Data structure containing information about input files.  */
7615 struct file_info
7616 {
7617   const char *path;	/* Complete file name.  */
7618   const char *fname;	/* File name part.  */
7619   int length;		/* Length of entire string.  */
7620   struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx;	/* Index in input file table.  */
7621   int dir_idx;		/* Index in directory table.  */
7622 };
7623 
7624 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7625    files.  */
7626 struct dir_info
7627 {
7628   const char *path;	/* Path including directory name.  */
7629   int length;		/* Path length.  */
7630   int prefix;		/* Index of directory entry which is a prefix.  */
7631   int count;		/* Number of files in this directory.  */
7632   int dir_idx;		/* Index of directory used as base.  */
7633 };
7634 
7635 /* Callback function for file_info comparison.  We sort by looking at
7636    the directories in the path.  */
7637 
7638 static int
file_info_cmp(const void * p1,const void * p2)7639 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7640 {
7641   const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7642   const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7643   unsigned char *cp1;
7644   unsigned char *cp2;
7645 
7646   /* Take care of file names without directories.  We need to make sure that
7647      we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7648      we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7649      orders.  So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7650      1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory.  */
7651   if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7652     return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7653 
7654   cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7655   cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7656 
7657   while (1)
7658     {
7659       ++cp1;
7660       ++cp2;
7661       /* Reached the end of the first path?  If so, handle like above.  */
7662       if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7663 	  || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7664 	return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7665 		- (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7666 
7667       /* Character of current path component the same?  */
7668       else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7669 	return *cp1 - *cp2;
7670     }
7671 }
7672 
7673 struct file_name_acquire_data
7674 {
7675   struct file_info *files;
7676   int used_files;
7677   int max_files;
7678 };
7679 
7680 /* Traversal function for the hash table.  */
7681 
7682 static int
file_name_acquire(void ** slot,void * data)7683 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7684 {
7685   struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7686   struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7687   struct file_info *fi;
7688   const char *f;
7689 
7690   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7691 
7692   if (! d->emitted_number)
7693     return 1;
7694 
7695   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7696 
7697   fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7698 
7699   /* Skip all leading "./".  */
7700   f = d->filename;
7701   while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7702     f += 2;
7703 
7704   /* Create a new array entry.  */
7705   fi->path = f;
7706   fi->length = strlen (f);
7707   fi->file_idx = d;
7708 
7709   /* Search for the file name part.  */
7710   f = strrchr (f, '/');
7711   fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7712   return 1;
7713 }
7714 
7715 /* Output the directory table and the file name table.  We try to minimize
7716    the total amount of memory needed.  A heuristic is used to avoid large
7717    slowdowns with many input files.  */
7718 
7719 static void
output_file_names(void)7720 output_file_names (void)
7721 {
7722   struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7723   int numfiles;
7724   struct file_info *files;
7725   struct dir_info *dirs;
7726   int *saved;
7727   int *savehere;
7728   int *backmap;
7729   int ndirs;
7730   int idx_offset;
7731   int i;
7732   int idx;
7733 
7734   if (!last_emitted_file)
7735     {
7736       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7737       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7738       return;
7739     }
7740 
7741   numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7742 
7743   /* Allocate the various arrays we need.  */
7744   files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7745   dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7746 
7747   fnad.files = files;
7748   fnad.used_files = 0;
7749   fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7750   htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7751   gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7752 
7753   qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7754 
7755   /* Find all the different directories used.  */
7756   dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7757   dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7758   dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7759   dirs[0].count = 1;
7760   dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7761   files[0].dir_idx = 0;
7762   ndirs = 1;
7763 
7764   for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
7765     if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7766 	&& memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7767 		   dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7768       {
7769 	/* Same directory as last entry.  */
7770 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7771 	++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7772       }
7773     else
7774       {
7775 	int j;
7776 
7777 	/* This is a new directory.  */
7778 	dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7779 	dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7780 	dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7781 	dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7782 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7783 
7784 	/* Search for a prefix.  */
7785 	dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7786 	for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7787 	  if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7788 	      && dirs[j].length > 1
7789 	      && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7790 		  || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7791 	      && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7792 	    dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7793 
7794 	++ndirs;
7795       }
7796 
7797   /* Now to the actual work.  We have to find a subset of the directories which
7798      allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7799      with the least amount of characters.  We do not do an exhaustive search
7800      where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7801      possible prefix.  Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7802      results in most cases and never is much off.  */
7803   saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7804   savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7805 
7806   memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7807   for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7808     {
7809       int j;
7810       int total;
7811 
7812       /* We can always save some space for the current directory.  But this
7813 	 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory.  */
7814       savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7815       total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7816 
7817       for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7818 	{
7819 	  savehere[j] = 0;
7820 	  if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7821 	    {
7822 	      /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7823 		 dirs[j] path.  */
7824 	      int k;
7825 
7826 	      k = dirs[j].prefix;
7827 	      while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7828 		k = dirs[k].prefix;
7829 
7830 	      if (k == (int) i)
7831 		{
7832 		  /* Yes it is.  We can possibly save some memory by
7833 		     writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7834 		     dirs[i].  */
7835 		  savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7836 		  total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7837 		}
7838 	    }
7839 	}
7840 
7841       /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7842 	 directory.  */
7843       if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7844 	{
7845 	  /* It's worthwhile adding.  */
7846 	  for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7847 	    if (savehere[j] > 0)
7848 	      {
7849 		/* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far.  */
7850 		saved[j] = savehere[j];
7851 
7852 		/* Remember the prefix directory.  */
7853 		dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7854 	      }
7855 	}
7856     }
7857 
7858   /* Emit the directory name table.  */
7859   idx = 1;
7860   idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7861   for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7862     dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7863 			    "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
7864 
7865   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7866 
7867   /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
7868      used in the debug info generation.  To do this efficiently we
7869      generate a back-mapping of the indices first.  */
7870   backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
7871   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7872     backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
7873 
7874   /* Now write all the file names.  */
7875   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7876     {
7877       int file_idx = backmap[i];
7878       int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7879 
7880       dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7881 			      "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
7882 
7883       /* Include directory index.  */
7884       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
7885 
7886       /* Modification time.  */
7887       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7888 
7889       /* File length in bytes.  */
7890       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7891     }
7892 
7893   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7894 }
7895 
7896 
7897 /* Output the source line number correspondence information.  This
7898    information goes into the .debug_line section.  */
7899 
7900 static void
output_line_info(void)7901 output_line_info (void)
7902 {
7903   char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7904   char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7905   char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7906   unsigned opc;
7907   unsigned n_op_args;
7908   unsigned long lt_index;
7909   unsigned long current_line;
7910   long line_offset;
7911   long line_delta;
7912   unsigned long current_file;
7913   unsigned long function;
7914 
7915   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7916   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7917   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7918   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7919 
7920   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7921     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7922       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7923   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7924 			"Length of Source Line Info");
7925   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7926 
7927   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7928   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7929   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7930 
7931   /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7932    bytes).  In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7933    information purposes only.  Since GCC generates assembly language,
7934    we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7935    generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7936    DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7937    commands.  Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7938    enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override.  */
7939   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7940 		       "Minimum Instruction Length");
7941 
7942   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7943 		       "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7944   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7945 		       "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7946   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7947 		       "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7948   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7949 		       "Special Opcode Base");
7950 
7951   for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7952     {
7953       switch (opc)
7954 	{
7955 	case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7956 	case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7957 	case DW_LNS_set_file:
7958 	case DW_LNS_set_column:
7959 	case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7960 	  n_op_args = 1;
7961 	  break;
7962 	default:
7963 	  n_op_args = 0;
7964 	  break;
7965 	}
7966 
7967       dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7968 			   opc, n_op_args);
7969     }
7970 
7971   /* Write out the information about the files we use.  */
7972   output_file_names ();
7973   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7974 
7975   /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7976      section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7977      have a line note for the opening brace of the first function.  */
7978 
7979   /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7980      a series of state machine operations.  */
7981   current_file = 1;
7982   current_line = 1;
7983 
7984   if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7985     strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7986   else
7987     strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7988   for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7989     {
7990       dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7991 
7992 #if 0
7993       /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7994 	 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7995 	 prologue.  */
7996 
7997       /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  Just updating the
7998 	 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7999 	 that anything after the last address is this line.  */
8000       if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8001 	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
8002 	continue;
8003 #endif
8004 
8005       /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8006 
8007 	 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8008 	 use the most general form.  GCC does not know the address delta
8009 	 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc.  Many ports do have length
8010 	 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range.  We
8011 	 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8012 	 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc.  */
8013 
8014       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
8015       if (0)
8016 	{
8017 	  /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff.  This takes 3 bytes.  */
8018 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8019 			       "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8020 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8021 	}
8022       else
8023 	{
8024 	  /* This can handle any delta.  This takes
8025 	     4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes.  */
8026 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8027 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8028 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8029 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8030 	}
8031 
8032       strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8033 
8034       /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8035 	 different from the previous line.  */
8036       if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8037 	{
8038 	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8039 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8040 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8041 	}
8042 
8043       /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8044 	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8045       if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8046 	{
8047 	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8048 	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8049 	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8050 	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8051 	    /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8052 	       definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.  This
8053 	       takes 1 byte.  */
8054 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8055 				 "line %lu", current_line);
8056 	  else
8057 	    {
8058 	      /* This can handle any delta.  This takes at least 4 bytes,
8059 		 depending on the value being encoded.  */
8060 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8061 				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8062 	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8063 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8064 	    }
8065 	}
8066       else
8067 	/* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn.  */
8068 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8069     }
8070 
8071   /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8072   if (0)
8073     {
8074       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8075 			   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8076       dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8077     }
8078   else
8079     {
8080       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8081       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8082       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8083       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8084     }
8085 
8086   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8087   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8088   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8089 
8090   function = 0;
8091   current_file = 1;
8092   current_line = 1;
8093   for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8094     {
8095       dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8096 	= &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8097 
8098 #if 0
8099       /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  */
8100       if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8101 	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8102 	  && line_info->function == function)
8103 	goto cont;
8104 #endif
8105 
8106       /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.  If this is
8107 	 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8108 	 to handle it differently.  */
8109       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8110 				   lt_index);
8111       if (function != line_info->function)
8112 	{
8113 	  function = line_info->function;
8114 
8115 	  /* Set the address register to the first line in the function.  */
8116 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8117 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8118 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8119 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8120 	}
8121       else
8122 	{
8123 	  /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above.  */
8124 	  if (0)
8125 	    {
8126 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8127 				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8128 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8129 	    }
8130 	  else
8131 	    {
8132 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8133 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8134 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8135 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8136 	    }
8137 	}
8138 
8139       strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8140 
8141       /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8142 	 different from the previous line.  */
8143       if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8144 	{
8145 	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8146 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8147 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8148 	}
8149 
8150       /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8151 	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8152       if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8153 	{
8154 	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8155 	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8156 	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8157 	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8158 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8159 				 "line %lu", current_line);
8160 	  else
8161 	    {
8162 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8163 				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8164 	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8165 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8166 	    }
8167 	}
8168       else
8169 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8170 
8171 #if 0
8172     cont:
8173 #endif
8174 
8175       lt_index++;
8176 
8177       /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence.  */
8178       if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8179 	  || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8180 	{
8181 	  current_file = 1;
8182 	  current_line = 1;
8183 
8184 	  /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8185 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8186 	  if (0)
8187 	    {
8188 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8189 				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8190 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8191 	    }
8192 	  else
8193 	    {
8194 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8195 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8196 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8197 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8198 	    }
8199 
8200 	  /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence.  */
8201 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8202 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8203 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8204 	}
8205     }
8206 
8207   /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info.  */
8208   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8209 }
8210 
8211 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8212    a DIE that describes the given type.
8213 
8214    This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8215    Dwarf base (fundamental) types.  */
8216 
8217 static dw_die_ref
base_type_die(tree type)8218 base_type_die (tree type)
8219 {
8220   dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8221   enum dwarf_type encoding;
8222 
8223   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8224     return 0;
8225 
8226   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8227     {
8228     case INTEGER_TYPE:
8229       if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8230 	{
8231 	  if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8232 	    encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8233 	  else
8234 	    encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8235 	}
8236       else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8237 	encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8238       else
8239 	encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8240       break;
8241 
8242     case REAL_TYPE:
8243       if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8244 	encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8245       else
8246 	encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8247       break;
8248 
8249       /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8250 	 a user defined type for it.  */
8251     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8252       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8253 	encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8254       else
8255 	encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8256       break;
8257 
8258     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8259       /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type.  */
8260       encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8261       break;
8262 
8263     default:
8264       /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types.  */
8265       gcc_unreachable ();
8266     }
8267 
8268   base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8269 
8270   /* This probably indicates a bug.  */
8271   if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8272     add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8273 
8274   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8275 		   int_size_in_bytes (type));
8276   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8277 
8278   return base_type_result;
8279 }
8280 
8281 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8282    the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type.  The Dwarf "root" type of
8283    a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8284    given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8285    type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8286    type.  (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8287    type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8288    root type of the given type without the qualifiers.  */
8289 
8290 static tree
root_type(tree type)8291 root_type (tree type)
8292 {
8293   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8294     return error_mark_node;
8295 
8296   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8297     {
8298     case ERROR_MARK:
8299       return error_mark_node;
8300 
8301     case POINTER_TYPE:
8302     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8303       return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8304 
8305     default:
8306       return type_main_variant (type);
8307     }
8308 }
8309 
8310 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8311    given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type.  Otherwise return null.  */
8312 
8313 static inline int
is_base_type(tree type)8314 is_base_type (tree type)
8315 {
8316   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8317     {
8318     case ERROR_MARK:
8319     case VOID_TYPE:
8320     case INTEGER_TYPE:
8321     case REAL_TYPE:
8322     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8323     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8324       return 1;
8325 
8326     case ARRAY_TYPE:
8327     case RECORD_TYPE:
8328     case UNION_TYPE:
8329     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8330     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8331     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8332     case METHOD_TYPE:
8333     case POINTER_TYPE:
8334     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8335     case OFFSET_TYPE:
8336     case LANG_TYPE:
8337     case VECTOR_TYPE:
8338       return 0;
8339 
8340     default:
8341       gcc_unreachable ();
8342     }
8343 
8344   return 0;
8345 }
8346 
8347 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8348    node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8349    return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8350    else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8351    ERROR_MARK node.  */
8352 
8353 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
simple_type_size_in_bits(tree type)8354 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8355 {
8356   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8357     return BITS_PER_WORD;
8358   else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8359     return 0;
8360   else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8361     return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8362   else
8363     return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8364 }
8365 
8366 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8367    emitted as a subrange type.  */
8368 
8369 static inline bool
is_subrange_type(tree type)8370 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8371 {
8372   tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8373 
8374   /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8375      types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8376      or an enumeral type.  */
8377 
8378   if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8379       || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8380     return false;
8381 
8382   if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8383       && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8384     return false;
8385 
8386   if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8387       && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8388       && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8389       && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8390       && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8391       && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8392       && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8393       && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8394     {
8395       /* The type and its subtype have the same representation.  If in
8396          addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8397          type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type.  */
8398       /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8399          Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized.  It should
8400          therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8401          rather than checking the actual size.  Unfortunately, we have
8402          found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8403          this is not the case.  Until this problem is solved, we need to
8404          keep checking the actual size.  */
8405       tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8406       tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8407 
8408       if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8409         type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8410 
8411       if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8412         subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8413 
8414       if (type_name == subtype_name)
8415         return false;
8416     }
8417 
8418   return true;
8419 }
8420 
8421 /*  Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8422     to a DIE that describes the given type.  */
8423 
8424 static dw_die_ref
subrange_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)8425 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8426 {
8427   dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8428   const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8429 
8430   if (context_die == NULL)
8431     context_die = comp_unit_die;
8432 
8433   subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8434 
8435   if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8436     {
8437       /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8438          so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type.  */
8439       add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8440     }
8441 
8442   if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8443     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8444                     TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8445   if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8446     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8447                     TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8448 
8449   return subrange_die;
8450 }
8451 
8452 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8453    entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type.  */
8454 
8455 static dw_die_ref
modified_type_die(tree type,int is_const_type,int is_volatile_type,dw_die_ref context_die)8456 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8457 		   dw_die_ref context_die)
8458 {
8459   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8460   dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8461   dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8462   tree item_type = NULL;
8463   tree qualified_type;
8464   tree name;
8465 
8466   if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8467     return NULL;
8468 
8469   /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8470      this type.  */
8471   qualified_type
8472     = get_qualified_type (type,
8473 			  ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8474 			   | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8475 
8476   /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists.  */
8477   if (qualified_type)
8478     {
8479       mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8480       if (mod_type_die)
8481 	return mod_type_die;
8482     }
8483 
8484   name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8485 
8486   /* Handle C typedef types.  */
8487   if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8488     {
8489       tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8490 
8491       if (qualified_type == dtype)
8492 	{
8493 	  /* For a named type, use the typedef.  */
8494 	  gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8495 	  return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8496 	}
8497       else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8498 	       || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8499 	       || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8500 		   && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8501 		   && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8502 	/* cv-unqualified version of named type.  Just use the unnamed
8503 	   type to which it refers.  */
8504 	return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8505 				  is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8506 				  context_die);
8507       /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through.  */
8508     }
8509 
8510   if (is_const_type)
8511     {
8512       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8513       sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8514     }
8515   else if (is_volatile_type)
8516     {
8517       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8518       sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8519     }
8520   else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8521     {
8522       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8523       add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8524 		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8525       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8526     }
8527   else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8528     {
8529       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8530       add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8531 		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8532       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8533     }
8534   else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8535     {
8536       mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8537       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8538     }
8539   else if (is_base_type (type))
8540     mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8541   else
8542     {
8543       gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8544 
8545       /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8546 	 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8547 	 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8548 	 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8549 	 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8550 	 ..._TYPE node.  */
8551       if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8552 	return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8553       else
8554 	/* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8555 	   not the main variant.  */
8556 	return lookup_type_die (type);
8557     }
8558 
8559   /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE.  For those,
8560      don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8561      user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.  */
8562   if (name
8563       && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8564     {
8565       if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8566 	/* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8567 	   but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8568 	   useful source coordinates anyway.  */
8569 	name = DECL_NAME (name);
8570       add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8571     }
8572 
8573   if (qualified_type)
8574     equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8575 
8576   if (item_type)
8577     /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8578        this is a recursive type.  This ensures that the modified_type_die
8579        recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive.  Recursive
8580        types are possible in Ada.  */
8581     sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8582 				 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8583 				 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8584 				 context_die);
8585 
8586   if (sub_die != NULL)
8587     add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8588 
8589   return mod_type_die;
8590 }
8591 
8592 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8593    an enumerated type.  */
8594 
8595 static inline int
type_is_enum(tree type)8596 type_is_enum (tree type)
8597 {
8598   return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8599 }
8600 
8601 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node.  */
8602 
8603 static unsigned int
dbx_reg_number(rtx rtl)8604 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8605 {
8606   unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8607 
8608   gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8609 
8610 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8611   if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8612     {
8613       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8614       if (leaf_reg != -1)
8615 	regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8616     }
8617 #endif
8618 
8619   return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8620 }
8621 
8622 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8623    DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8624    doesn't end with DW_OP_piece.  */
8625 
8626 static void
add_loc_descr_op_piece(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,int size)8627 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8628 {
8629   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8630 
8631   if (*list_head != NULL)
8632     {
8633       /* Find the end of the chain.  */
8634       for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8635 	;
8636 
8637       if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8638 	loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8639     }
8640 }
8641 
8642 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8643    zero if there is none.  */
8644 
8645 static dw_loc_descr_ref
reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)8646 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8647 {
8648   rtx regs;
8649 
8650   if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8651     return 0;
8652 
8653   regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8654 
8655   if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8656     return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8657   else
8658     return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8659 }
8660 
8661 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8662    a given hard register number.  */
8663 
8664 static dw_loc_descr_ref
one_reg_loc_descriptor(unsigned int regno)8665 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8666 {
8667   if (regno <= 31)
8668     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8669   else
8670     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8671 }
8672 
8673 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8674    designates a value that spans more than one register.  */
8675 
8676 static dw_loc_descr_ref
multiple_reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,rtx regs)8677 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8678 {
8679   int nregs, size, i;
8680   unsigned reg;
8681   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8682 
8683   reg = REGNO (rtl);
8684 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8685   if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8686     {
8687       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8688       if (leaf_reg != -1)
8689 	reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8690     }
8691 #endif
8692   gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8693   nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8694 
8695   /* Simple, contiguous registers.  */
8696   if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8697     {
8698       size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8699 
8700       loc_result = NULL;
8701       while (nregs--)
8702 	{
8703 	  dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8704 
8705 	  t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8706 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8707 	  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8708 	  ++reg;
8709 	}
8710       return loc_result;
8711     }
8712 
8713   /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations.  */
8714 
8715   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8716 
8717   size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8718   loc_result = NULL;
8719 
8720   for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8721     {
8722       dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8723 
8724       t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8725       add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8726       size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8727       add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8728     }
8729   return loc_result;
8730 }
8731 
8732 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant.  */
8733 
8734 static dw_loc_descr_ref
int_loc_descriptor(HOST_WIDE_INT i)8735 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8736 {
8737   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8738 
8739   /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8740      defaulting to the LEB encoding.  */
8741   if (i >= 0)
8742     {
8743       if (i <= 31)
8744 	op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8745       else if (i <= 0xff)
8746 	op = DW_OP_const1u;
8747       else if (i <= 0xffff)
8748 	op = DW_OP_const2u;
8749       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8750 	       || i <= 0xffffffff)
8751 	op = DW_OP_const4u;
8752       else
8753 	op = DW_OP_constu;
8754     }
8755   else
8756     {
8757       if (i >= -0x80)
8758 	op = DW_OP_const1s;
8759       else if (i >= -0x8000)
8760 	op = DW_OP_const2s;
8761       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8762 	       || i >= -0x80000000)
8763 	op = DW_OP_const4s;
8764       else
8765 	op = DW_OP_consts;
8766     }
8767 
8768   return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8769 }
8770 
8771 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location.  */
8772 
8773 static dw_loc_descr_ref
based_loc_descr(rtx reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)8774 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8775 {
8776   unsigned int regno;
8777 
8778   /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8779      post-prologue local stack frame.  We do this by *not* running
8780      register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8781      argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.  */
8782   if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8783     {
8784       rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8785 
8786       if (elim != reg)
8787 	{
8788 	  if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8789 	    {
8790 	      offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8791 	      elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8792 	    }
8793 	  gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8794 		      : stack_pointer_rtx));
8795           offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8796 
8797           return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8798 	}
8799     }
8800 
8801   regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8802   if (regno <= 31)
8803     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8804   else
8805     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8806 }
8807 
8808 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation.  */
8809 
8810 static inline int
is_based_loc(rtx rtl)8811 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8812 {
8813   return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8814 	  && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8815 	       && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8816 	       && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8817 }
8818 
8819 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8820    (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8821    mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8822    hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8823 
8824    When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8825    the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8826    equivalent.  This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8827    it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8828 
8829    MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8830    autoincrement addressing modes.
8831 
8832    CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8833    location list for RTL.
8834 
8835    Return 0 if we can't represent the location.  */
8836 
8837 static dw_loc_descr_ref
mem_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,enum machine_mode mode)8838 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8839 {
8840   dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8841   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8842 
8843   /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8844      description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8845      actually within the array.  That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8846      zeroth element of the array.  */
8847 
8848   rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8849 
8850   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8851     {
8852     case POST_INC:
8853     case POST_DEC:
8854     case POST_MODIFY:
8855       /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG.  So we
8856 	 just fall into the SUBREG code.  */
8857 
8858       /* ... fall through ...  */
8859 
8860     case SUBREG:
8861       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8862 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8863 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
8864 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8865 	 contains the given subreg.  */
8866       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8867 
8868       /* ... fall through ...  */
8869 
8870     case REG:
8871       /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8872 	 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8873 	 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8874 	 a "base register".  This distinction is not based in any way upon
8875 	 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8876 	 belongs to.  This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8877 	 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8878 	 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8879 	 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8880 	 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg).  This may look deceptively like
8881 	 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8882 	 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8883 	 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG.  */
8884       if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8885 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8886       break;
8887 
8888     case MEM:
8889       mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8890       if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8891 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8892       break;
8893 
8894     case LO_SUM:
8895 	 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8896 
8897       /* ... fall through ...  */
8898 
8899     case LABEL_REF:
8900       /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8901 	 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8902 	 pool.  */
8903     case CONST:
8904     case SYMBOL_REF:
8905       /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8906 	 by a different symbol.  */
8907       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8908 	{
8909 	  bool marked;
8910 	  rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8911 
8912 	  if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8913 	    {
8914 	      rtl = tmp;
8915 	      if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8916 		get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8917 	      else
8918 		marked = true;
8919 	    }
8920 
8921 	  /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8922 	     it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8923 	     FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8924 	     DW_OP_piece complicates it.  */
8925 	  if (!marked)
8926 	    return 0;
8927 	}
8928 
8929       mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8930       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8931       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8932       VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8933       break;
8934 
8935     case PRE_MODIFY:
8936       /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8937 	 PLUS code below.  */
8938       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8939       goto plus;
8940 
8941     case PRE_INC:
8942     case PRE_DEC:
8943       /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8944 	 below.  */
8945       rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8946 			  GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8947 				   ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8948 				   : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8949 
8950       /* ... fall through ...  */
8951 
8952     case PLUS:
8953     plus:
8954       if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8955 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8956 					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8957       else
8958 	{
8959 	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8960 	  if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8961 	    break;
8962 
8963 	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8964 	      && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8965 	    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8966 			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8967 					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8968 	  else
8969 	    {
8970 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8971 			     mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8972 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8973 			     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8974 	    }
8975 	}
8976       break;
8977 
8978     /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8979        be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift.  */
8980     case MULT:
8981       op = DW_OP_mul;
8982       goto do_binop;
8983 
8984     case ASHIFT:
8985       op = DW_OP_shl;
8986       goto do_binop;
8987 
8988     case ASHIFTRT:
8989       op = DW_OP_shra;
8990       goto do_binop;
8991 
8992     case LSHIFTRT:
8993       op = DW_OP_shr;
8994       goto do_binop;
8995 
8996     do_binop:
8997       {
8998 	dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8999 	dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
9000 
9001 	if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
9002 	  break;
9003 
9004 	mem_loc_result = op0;
9005 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
9006 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9007 	break;
9008       }
9009 
9010     case CONST_INT:
9011       mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
9012       break;
9013 
9014     default:
9015       gcc_unreachable ();
9016     }
9017 
9018   return mem_loc_result;
9019 }
9020 
9021 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9022    This is typically a complex variable.  */
9023 
9024 static dw_loc_descr_ref
concat_loc_descriptor(rtx x0,rtx x1)9025 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
9026 {
9027   dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9028   dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
9029   dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
9030 
9031   if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
9032     return 0;
9033 
9034   cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
9035   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
9036 
9037   add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
9038   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
9039 
9040   return cc_loc_result;
9041 }
9042 
9043 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9044    which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location.  For a
9045    register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number.  For a
9046    memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9047    generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9048 
9049    If we don't know how to describe it, return 0.  */
9050 
9051 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)9052 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
9053 {
9054   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9055 
9056   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9057     {
9058     case SUBREG:
9059       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9060 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9061 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
9062 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9063 	 contains the given subreg.  */
9064       rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9065 
9066       /* ... fall through ...  */
9067 
9068     case REG:
9069       loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9070       break;
9071 
9072     case MEM:
9073       loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
9074       break;
9075 
9076     case CONCAT:
9077       loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
9078       break;
9079 
9080     case VAR_LOCATION:
9081       /* Single part.  */
9082       if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9083 	{
9084 	  loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
9085 	  break;
9086 	}
9087 
9088       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9089       /* FALLTHRU */
9090 
9091     case PARALLEL:
9092       {
9093 	rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9094 	int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9095 	enum machine_mode mode;
9096 	int i;
9097 
9098 	/* Create the first one, so we have something to add to.  */
9099 	loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9100 	mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9101 	add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9102 	for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9103 	  {
9104 	    dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9105 
9106 	    temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9107 	    add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9108 	    mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9109 	    add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9110 	  }
9111       }
9112       break;
9113 
9114     default:
9115       gcc_unreachable ();
9116     }
9117 
9118   return loc_result;
9119 }
9120 
9121 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl.  This comes
9122    up particularly with variable length arrays.  WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9123    a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9124    top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9125    the value of LOC.  */
9126 
9127 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree_1(tree loc,int want_address)9128 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9129 {
9130   dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9131   int have_address = 0;
9132   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9133 
9134   /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9135      extending the values properly.  Hopefully this won't be a real
9136      problem...  */
9137 
9138   switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9139     {
9140     case ERROR_MARK:
9141       return 0;
9142 
9143     case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9144       /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9145 	 position of other fields.  We don't try to encode this here.  The
9146 	 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9147 	 the names of types.  */
9148       return 0;
9149 
9150     case CALL_EXPR:
9151       return 0;
9152 
9153     case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9154     case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9155     case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9156     case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9157       /* There are no opcodes for these operations.  */
9158       return 0;
9159 
9160     case ADDR_EXPR:
9161       /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do.  */
9162       if (want_address)
9163 	return 0;
9164 
9165       /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address.  */
9166       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9167 
9168     case VAR_DECL:
9169       if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9170 	{
9171 	  rtx rtl;
9172 
9173 	  /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data.  */
9174 	  if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9175 	    return 0;
9176 
9177 	  /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9178 	     look up addresses of objects in the current module.  */
9179 	  if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9180 	    return 0;
9181 
9182 	  rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9183 	  if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9184 	    return 0;
9185 
9186 	  if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9187 	    return 0;
9188 	  rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9189 	  if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9190 	    return 0;
9191 
9192 	  ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9193 	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9194 	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9195 
9196 	  ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9197 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9198 
9199 	  have_address = 1;
9200 	  break;
9201 	}
9202       /* FALLTHRU */
9203 
9204     case PARM_DECL:
9205       if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9206 	return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9207 					   want_address);
9208       /* FALLTHRU */
9209 
9210     case RESULT_DECL:
9211     case FUNCTION_DECL:
9212       {
9213 	rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9214 
9215 	if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9216 	  return 0;
9217         else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9218 	  {
9219 	    HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9220 	    if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9221 	      val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9222 	    ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9223 	  }
9224 	else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9225 	  return 0;
9226 	else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9227 	  {
9228 	    ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9229 	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9230 	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9231 	  }
9232 	else
9233 	  {
9234 	    enum machine_mode mode;
9235 
9236 	    /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level.  */
9237 	    if (want_address == 2)
9238 	      return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9239 
9240 	    mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9241 	    if (MEM_P (rtl))
9242 	      {
9243 		rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9244 		have_address = 1;
9245 	      }
9246 	    ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9247 	  }
9248       }
9249       break;
9250 
9251     case INDIRECT_REF:
9252       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9253       have_address = 1;
9254       break;
9255 
9256     case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9257       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9258 
9259     case NOP_EXPR:
9260     case CONVERT_EXPR:
9261     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9262     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9263     case SAVE_EXPR:
9264     case MODIFY_EXPR:
9265       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9266 
9267     case COMPONENT_REF:
9268     case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9269     case ARRAY_REF:
9270     case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9271       {
9272 	tree obj, offset;
9273 	HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9274 	enum machine_mode mode;
9275 	int volatilep;
9276 	int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9277 
9278 	obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9279 				   &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9280 
9281 	if (obj == loc)
9282 	  return 0;
9283 
9284 	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9285 	if (ret == 0
9286 	    || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9287 	  return 0;
9288 
9289 	if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9290 	  {
9291 	    /* Variable offset.  */
9292 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9293 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9294 	  }
9295 
9296 	bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9297 	if (bytepos > 0)
9298 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9299 	else if (bytepos < 0)
9300 	  {
9301 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9302 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9303 	  }
9304 
9305 	have_address = 1;
9306 	break;
9307       }
9308 
9309     case INTEGER_CST:
9310       if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9311 	ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9312       else
9313 	return 0;
9314       break;
9315 
9316     case CONSTRUCTOR:
9317       {
9318 	/* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted.  */
9319 	rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9320 	enum machine_mode mode;
9321 
9322 	if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9323 	  return 0;
9324 	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9325 	rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9326 	ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9327 	have_address = 1;
9328 	break;
9329       }
9330 
9331     case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9332     case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9333     case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9334       op = DW_OP_and;
9335       goto do_binop;
9336 
9337     case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9338     case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9339       op = DW_OP_xor;
9340       goto do_binop;
9341 
9342     case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9343     case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9344     case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9345       op = DW_OP_or;
9346       goto do_binop;
9347 
9348     case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9349     case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9350     case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9351     case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9352       op = DW_OP_div;
9353       goto do_binop;
9354 
9355     case MINUS_EXPR:
9356       op = DW_OP_minus;
9357       goto do_binop;
9358 
9359     case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9360     case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9361     case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9362     case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9363       op = DW_OP_mod;
9364       goto do_binop;
9365 
9366     case MULT_EXPR:
9367       op = DW_OP_mul;
9368       goto do_binop;
9369 
9370     case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9371       op = DW_OP_shl;
9372       goto do_binop;
9373 
9374     case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9375       op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9376       goto do_binop;
9377 
9378     case PLUS_EXPR:
9379       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9380 	  && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9381 	{
9382 	  ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9383 	  if (ret == 0)
9384 	    return 0;
9385 
9386 	  add_loc_descr (&ret,
9387 			 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9388 					tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9389 						      0),
9390 					0));
9391 	  break;
9392 	}
9393 
9394       op = DW_OP_plus;
9395       goto do_binop;
9396 
9397     case LE_EXPR:
9398       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9399 	return 0;
9400 
9401       op = DW_OP_le;
9402       goto do_binop;
9403 
9404     case GE_EXPR:
9405       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9406 	return 0;
9407 
9408       op = DW_OP_ge;
9409       goto do_binop;
9410 
9411     case LT_EXPR:
9412       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9413 	return 0;
9414 
9415       op = DW_OP_lt;
9416       goto do_binop;
9417 
9418     case GT_EXPR:
9419       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9420 	return 0;
9421 
9422       op = DW_OP_gt;
9423       goto do_binop;
9424 
9425     case EQ_EXPR:
9426       op = DW_OP_eq;
9427       goto do_binop;
9428 
9429     case NE_EXPR:
9430       op = DW_OP_ne;
9431       goto do_binop;
9432 
9433     do_binop:
9434       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9435       ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9436       if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9437 	return 0;
9438 
9439       add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9440       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9441       break;
9442 
9443     case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9444     case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9445       op = DW_OP_not;
9446       goto do_unop;
9447 
9448     case ABS_EXPR:
9449       op = DW_OP_abs;
9450       goto do_unop;
9451 
9452     case NEGATE_EXPR:
9453       op = DW_OP_neg;
9454       goto do_unop;
9455 
9456     do_unop:
9457       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9458       if (ret == 0)
9459 	return 0;
9460 
9461       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9462       break;
9463 
9464     case MIN_EXPR:
9465     case MAX_EXPR:
9466       {
9467         const enum tree_code code =
9468           TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9469 
9470         loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9471 		      build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9472 			      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9473                       TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9474       }
9475 
9476       /* ... fall through ...  */
9477 
9478     case COND_EXPR:
9479       {
9480 	dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9481 	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9482 	dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9483 	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9484 	dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9485 
9486 	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9487 	if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9488 	  return 0;
9489 
9490 	bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9491 	add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9492 
9493 	add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9494 	jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9495 	add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9496 
9497 	add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9498 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9499 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9500 
9501 	/* ??? Need a node to point the skip at.  Use a nop.  */
9502 	tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9503 	add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9504 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9505 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9506       }
9507       break;
9508 
9509     case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9510     case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9511     case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9512     case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9513       return 0;
9514 
9515     default:
9516       /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown.  This comes
9517 	 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR.  */
9518       if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9519           >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9520 	return 0;
9521 
9522 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9523       /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9524 	 these explicitly.  We forgot one.  */
9525       gcc_unreachable ();
9526 #else
9527       /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9528 	 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash.  */
9529       return NULL;
9530 #endif
9531     }
9532 
9533   /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address.  */
9534   if (want_address && !have_address)
9535     return 0;
9536 
9537   /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference.  */
9538   if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9539     {
9540       HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9541 
9542       if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9543 	return 0;
9544       else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9545 	op = DW_OP_deref;
9546       else
9547 	op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9548 
9549       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9550     }
9551 
9552   return ret;
9553 }
9554 
9555 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree(tree loc)9556 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9557 {
9558   return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9559 }
9560 
9561 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9562    which is not less than the value itself.  */
9563 
9564 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
ceiling(HOST_WIDE_INT value,unsigned int boundary)9565 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9566 {
9567   return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9568 }
9569 
9570 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9571    pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9572    `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9573    ERROR_MARK node.  */
9574 
9575 static inline tree
field_type(tree decl)9576 field_type (tree decl)
9577 {
9578   tree type;
9579 
9580   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9581     return integer_type_node;
9582 
9583   type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9584   if (type == NULL_TREE)
9585     type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9586 
9587   return type;
9588 }
9589 
9590 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9591    it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9592    be an ERROR_MARK node.  */
9593 
9594 static inline unsigned
simple_type_align_in_bits(tree type)9595 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9596 {
9597   return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9598 }
9599 
9600 static inline unsigned
simple_decl_align_in_bits(tree decl)9601 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9602 {
9603   return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9604 }
9605 
9606 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9607    lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9608    or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9609    because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9610    because the offset is actually variable.  (We can't handle the latter case
9611    just yet).  */
9612 
9613 static HOST_WIDE_INT
field_byte_offset(tree decl)9614 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9615 {
9616   unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9617   unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9618   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9619   HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9620   tree type;
9621   tree field_size_tree;
9622   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9623   HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9624   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9625 
9626   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9627     return 0;
9628 
9629   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9630 
9631   type = field_type (decl);
9632   field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9633 
9634   /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9635      a flexible array member.  */
9636   if (! field_size_tree)
9637     field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9638 
9639   /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9640      for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0.  Someday, we may
9641      be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult.  */
9642   if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9643     return 0;
9644 
9645   bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9646 
9647   /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word.  */
9648   if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9649     field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9650   else
9651     field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9652 
9653   type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9654   type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9655   decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9656 
9657   /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9658      bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9659      hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field.  Thus, when computing
9660      the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9661      bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9662      tricky to do in some cases.  For example, handling the following structure
9663      type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9664      long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9665 
9666 	 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9667 
9668      Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9669      cases.  When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9670      structure shown above.  It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9671      for bit-field allocation.  GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9672      bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9673      boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9674      of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9675      there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9676      (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9677      bits of the bit-field itself.
9678 
9679      This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9680      object of the structure type shown above.  When looking for a place to
9681      allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9682      to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9683      boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9684      bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9685      bits remain within that selected 64 bit field.  (As it turns out, for the
9686      example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9687      object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9688 
9689      Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9690      given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9691      that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9692      we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9693      DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9694      and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well).  */
9695 
9696   /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9697      "deepest" bit of the bit-field.  */
9698   deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9699 
9700   /* This is the tricky part.  Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9701      lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be.  */
9702   object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9703 
9704   /* Round up to type_align by default.  This works best for bitfields.  */
9705   object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9706   object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9707   object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9708 
9709   if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9710     {
9711       /* Sigh, the decl must be packed.  */
9712       object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9713 
9714       /* Round up to decl_align instead.  */
9715       object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9716       object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9717       object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9718     }
9719 
9720   return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9721 }
9722 
9723 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9724    associated with them.  */
9725 
9726 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9727 
9728    This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9729    whole parameters.  Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9730    generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below.  */
9731 
9732 static inline void
add_AT_location_description(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)9733 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9734 			     dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9735 {
9736   if (descr != 0)
9737     add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9738 }
9739 
9740 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9741    struct and union types.  In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9742    represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9743    descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9744    byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9745    the "containing object" for the bit-field.  (See the `field_byte_offset'
9746    function above).
9747 
9748    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9749    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
9750    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9751    declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9752    DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this).  Note that it is the size (in
9753    bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9754    DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.  (See the
9755    `byte_size_attribute' function below.)  It is also used when calculating the
9756    value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute.  (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9757    function below.)  */
9758 
9759 static void
add_data_member_location_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)9760 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9761 {
9762   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9763   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9764 
9765   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9766     {
9767       /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class.  */
9768       if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9769 	{
9770 	  /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9771 	     aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9772 	     type.  We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9773 	     vtable.  The following dwarf expression means
9774 
9775 	       BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9776 
9777 	     This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course.  */
9778 
9779 	  dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9780 
9781 	  /* Make a copy of the object address.  */
9782 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9783 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9784 
9785 	  /* Extract the vtable address.  */
9786 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9787 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9788 
9789 	  /* Calculate the address of the offset.  */
9790 	  offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9791 	  gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9792 
9793 	  tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9794 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9795 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9796 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9797 
9798 	  /* Extract the offset.  */
9799 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9800 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9801 
9802 	  /* Add it to the object address.  */
9803 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9804 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9805 	}
9806       else
9807 	offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9808     }
9809   else
9810     offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9811 
9812   if (! loc_descr)
9813     {
9814       enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9815 
9816       /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9817 	 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9818 	 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst.  */
9819 
9820 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9821       /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9822 	 operator correctly.  It works only if we leave the offset on the
9823 	 stack.  */
9824       op = DW_OP_constu;
9825 #else
9826       op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9827 #endif
9828 
9829       loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9830     }
9831 
9832   add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9833 }
9834 
9835 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9836 
9837 static void
insert_int(HOST_WIDE_INT val,unsigned int size,unsigned char * dest)9838 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9839 {
9840   while (size != 0)
9841     {
9842       *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9843       val >>= 8;
9844       --size;
9845     }
9846 }
9847 
9848 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array.  Inverse of insert_int.  */
9849 
9850 static HOST_WIDE_INT
extract_int(const unsigned char * src,unsigned int size)9851 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9852 {
9853   HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9854 
9855   src += size;
9856   while (size != 0)
9857     {
9858       val <<= 8;
9859       val |= *--src & 0xff;
9860       --size;
9861     }
9862   return val;
9863 }
9864 
9865 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9866 
9867 static void
insert_float(rtx rtl,unsigned char * array)9868 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9869 {
9870   REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9871   long val[4];
9872   int i;
9873 
9874   REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9875   real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9876 
9877   /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long.  Pack them.  */
9878   for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9879     {
9880       insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9881       array += 4;
9882     }
9883 }
9884 
9885 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9886    does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register.  These
9887    things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9888    to an inlined function.  They can also arise in C++ where declared
9889    constants do not necessarily get memory "homes".  */
9890 
9891 static void
add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,rtx rtl)9892 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9893 {
9894   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9895     {
9896     case CONST_INT:
9897       {
9898 	HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9899 
9900 	if (val < 0)
9901 	  add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9902 	else
9903 	  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9904       }
9905       break;
9906 
9907     case CONST_DOUBLE:
9908       /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9909 	 floating-point constant.  A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9910 	 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9911 	 represented.  We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks.  */
9912       {
9913 	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9914 
9915 	if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9916 	  {
9917 	    unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9918 	    unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9919 
9920 	    insert_float (rtl, array);
9921 	    add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9922 	  }
9923 	else
9924 	  {
9925 	    /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout.  */
9926 	    gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9927 
9928 	    add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9929 			      CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9930 	  }
9931       }
9932       break;
9933 
9934     case CONST_VECTOR:
9935       {
9936 	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9937 	unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9938 	unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9939 	unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9940 	unsigned int i;
9941 	unsigned char *p;
9942 
9943 	switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9944 	  {
9945 	  case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9946 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9947 	      {
9948 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9949 		HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9950 
9951 		switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9952 		  {
9953 		  case CONST_INT:
9954 		    lo = INTVAL (elt);
9955 		    hi = -(lo < 0);
9956 		    break;
9957 
9958 		  case CONST_DOUBLE:
9959 		    lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9960 		    hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9961 		    break;
9962 
9963 		  default:
9964 		    gcc_unreachable ();
9965 		  }
9966 
9967 		if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9968 		  insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9969 		else
9970 		  {
9971 		    unsigned char *p0 = p;
9972 		    unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9973 
9974 		    gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9975 		    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9976 		      {
9977 			p0 = p1;
9978 			p1 = p;
9979 		      }
9980 		    insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9981 		    insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9982 		  }
9983 	      }
9984 	    break;
9985 
9986 	  case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9987 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9988 	      {
9989 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9990 		insert_float (elt, p);
9991 	      }
9992 	    break;
9993 
9994 	  default:
9995 	    gcc_unreachable ();
9996 	  }
9997 
9998 	add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
9999       }
10000       break;
10001 
10002     case CONST_STRING:
10003       add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
10004       break;
10005 
10006     case SYMBOL_REF:
10007     case LABEL_REF:
10008     case CONST:
10009       add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
10010       VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
10011       break;
10012 
10013     case PLUS:
10014       /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10015 	 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10016 	 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10017 	 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10018 	 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10019 	 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)).  This is not
10020 	 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10021 	 of the (artificial) local variable either.  Rather, it represents the
10022 	 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10023 	 lifetime.  We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10024 	 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing.  */
10025       break;
10026 
10027     default:
10028       /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here.  */
10029       gcc_unreachable ();
10030     }
10031 
10032 }
10033 
10034 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10035    or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10036    output).  */
10037 static tree
reference_to_unused(tree * tp,int * walk_subtrees,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)10038 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
10039 		     void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10040 {
10041   if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10042     *walk_subtrees = 0;
10043 
10044   if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10045       && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10046     return *tp;
10047   else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time)
10048     return NULL_TREE;
10049   else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10050 	   && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
10051     return *tp;
10052   else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
10053     {
10054       struct cgraph_varpool_node *node = cgraph_varpool_node (*tp);
10055       if (!node->needed)
10056 	return *tp;
10057     }
10058    else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
10059 	    && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
10060     {
10061       struct cgraph_node *node = cgraph_node (*tp);
10062       if (!node->output)
10063         return *tp;
10064     }
10065 
10066   return NULL_TREE;
10067 }
10068 
10069 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10070    for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call.  */
10071 
10072 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_init(tree init,tree type)10073 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10074 {
10075   rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10076 
10077   /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10078      zeros, build CONST_STRING.  */
10079   if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10080     {
10081       tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10082       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10083       enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10084 
10085       if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10086 	  && domain
10087 	  && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10088 	  && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10089 			       TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10090 	  && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10091 	      == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10092 	rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10093 				    ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10094     }
10095   /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10096      CONCAT: FIXME!  */
10097   else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10098     ;
10099   /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10100      FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too.  */
10101   else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10102     ;
10103   /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10104      immediate RTL constant, expand it now.  We must be careful not to
10105      reference variables which won't be output.  */
10106   else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10107 	   && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10108     {
10109       /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10110 	 possible.  */
10111       if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10112 	switch (TREE_CODE (init))
10113 	  {
10114 	  case VECTOR_CST:
10115 	    break;
10116 	  case CONSTRUCTOR:
10117 	    if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
10118 	      {
10119 		VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
10120 		bool constant_p = true;
10121 		tree value;
10122 		unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10123 
10124 		/* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10125 		   elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10126 		   belong into VECTOR_CST nodes.  */
10127 		FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
10128 		  if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
10129 		    {
10130 		      constant_p = false;
10131 		      break;
10132 		    }
10133 
10134 		if (constant_p)
10135 		  {
10136 		    init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
10137 		    break;
10138 		  }
10139 	      }
10140 	    /* FALLTHRU */
10141 
10142 	  default:
10143 	    return NULL;
10144 	  }
10145 
10146       rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10147 
10148       /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate.  */
10149       gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10150     }
10151 
10152   return rtl;
10153 }
10154 
10155 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location.  */
10156 
10157 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_location(tree decl)10158 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10159 {
10160   rtx rtl;
10161 
10162   /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10163      (as far as the debugger is concerned).  We only have a couple of
10164      choices.  GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10165 
10166      DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10167      activation of the function.  If optimization is enabled however, this
10168      could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg.  Both of those cases indicate
10169      that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10170      generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10171      activation.  That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10172      referenced within the function.
10173 
10174      We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10175      non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10176      a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10177      where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10178 
10179      Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10180      a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases.  In cases
10181      where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10182      we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10183      declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10184      points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10185 
10186      In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10187      we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10188      because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10189      type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself.  Thus,
10190      if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10191      such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10192      `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10193      `double'.  That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10194      output at debug-time.
10195 
10196      So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10197      in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl).  There
10198      are a couple of exceptions however.  On little-endian machines we can
10199      get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10200      not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10201      an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10202      when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10203      parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'.  In such cases,
10204      TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10205      be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10206      passed `int' value.  If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10207      a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10208      the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10209 
10210      Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10211      parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10212      end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue).  We'll do that as best
10213      as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10214      sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10215      debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10216      value rather than the value which was originally passed in.  This happens
10217      rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10218      I'd like to fix it.
10219 
10220      A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10221      any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10222      type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10223      to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10224      "active location" for each parameter.  This additional set of attributes
10225      could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10226      sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10227      This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10228      parameters which are never referenced.  This really shouldn't be
10229      happening.  All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10230      DECL_INCOMING_RTL values.  FIXME.  */
10231 
10232   /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better.  */
10233   rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10234 
10235   /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10236      constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10237      fixed registers.  */
10238   if (! reload_completed)
10239     {
10240       if (rtl
10241 	  && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10242 	      || (MEM_P (rtl)
10243 	          && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10244 	      || (REG_P (rtl)
10245 	          && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10246 		  && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10247 	{
10248 	  rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10249 	  return rtl;
10250 	}
10251       rtl = NULL_RTX;
10252     }
10253   else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10254     {
10255       if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10256 	{
10257 	  tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10258 	  tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10259 	  enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10260 	  enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10261 
10262 	  /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10263 	     Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10264 	     all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below.  */
10265 	  if (dmode == pmode)
10266 	    rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10267 	  else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10268 		   && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10269 		   && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10270 	    {
10271 	      rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10272 	      if (REG_P (inc))
10273 		rtl = inc;
10274 	      else if (MEM_P (inc))
10275 		{
10276 		  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10277 		    rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10278 					     GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10279 					     - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10280 		  else
10281 		    rtl = inc;
10282 		}
10283 	    }
10284 	}
10285 
10286       /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10287 	 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10288 	 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl.  */
10289       /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10290 	 we reach the big endian correction code there.  It isn't clear if all
10291 	 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10292 	 thing to do.  */
10293       else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10294 	       && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10295 	       && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10296 	       /* Not passed in memory.  */
10297 	       && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10298 	       /* Not passed by invisible reference.  */
10299 	       && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10300 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10301 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10302 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10303 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10304 #endif
10305 		     )
10306 	       /* Big endian correction check.  */
10307 	       && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10308 	       && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10309 	       && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10310 		   < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10311 	{
10312 	  int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10313 			- GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10314 
10315 	  rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10316 			     plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10317 	}
10318     }
10319   else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10320 	   && rtl
10321 	   && MEM_P (rtl)
10322 	   && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10323 	   && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10324     {
10325       int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10326       int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10327 
10328       /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10329 	 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10330 	 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10331 	 fact we are not.  We need to adjust the offset of the
10332 	 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10333 	 else gdb will not be able to display it.  */
10334       if (rsize > dsize)
10335 	rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10336 			   plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10337     }
10338 
10339   /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10340      and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10341      C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do.  */
10342   if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10343     rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10344 
10345   if (rtl)
10346     rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10347 
10348   /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10349      reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10350      code, and thus is not emitted.  */
10351   if (rtl)
10352     rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10353 
10354   return rtl;
10355 }
10356 
10357 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10358    address ranges where a given location is valid.
10359    1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10360    2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10361    3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10362    XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice.  */
10363 
10364 static const char *
secname_for_decl(tree decl)10365 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10366 {
10367   const char *secname;
10368 
10369   if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10370     {
10371       tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10372       secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10373     }
10374   else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10375     {
10376       tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10377       secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10378     }
10379   else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10380     secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10381   else
10382     secname = text_section_label;
10383 
10384   return secname;
10385 }
10386 
10387 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10388    data attribute for a variable or a parameter.  We generate the
10389    DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10390    or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10391    register.  This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10392    actual argument in a call to an inline function.  (It's possible that
10393    these things can crop up in other ways also.)  Note that one type of
10394    constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10395    pointer.  This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10396    function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.  */
10397 
10398 static void
add_location_or_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl,enum dwarf_attribute attr)10399 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10400 				       enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10401 {
10402   rtx rtl;
10403   dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10404   var_loc_list *loc_list;
10405   struct var_loc_node *node;
10406   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10407     return;
10408 
10409   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10410 	      || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10411 
10412   /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable.  */
10413   loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10414 
10415   /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10416      differ.  */
10417   if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10418     {
10419       const char *endname, *secname;
10420       dw_loc_list_ref list;
10421       rtx varloc;
10422 
10423       /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10424          actually construct the list of locations.
10425 	 The first location information is what is passed to the
10426 	 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10427 	 locations just get added on to that list.
10428 	 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10429 	 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10430 	 the range [current location start, next location start].
10431 	 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10432 	 a range of [last location start, end of function label].  */
10433 
10434       node = loc_list->first;
10435       varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10436       secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10437 
10438       list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10439 			   node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10440       node = node->next;
10441 
10442       for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10443 	if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10444 	  {
10445 	    /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10446 	       NODE->NEXT->LABEL.  */
10447 	    varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10448 	    add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10449 				       node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10450 	  }
10451 
10452       /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10453 	 it keeps its location until the end of function.  */
10454       if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10455 	{
10456 	  char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10457 
10458 	  varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10459 	  if (!current_function_decl)
10460 	    endname = text_end_label;
10461 	  else
10462 	    {
10463 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10464 					   current_function_funcdef_no);
10465 	      endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10466 	    }
10467 	  add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10468 				     node->label, endname, secname);
10469 	}
10470 
10471       /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done.  */
10472       add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10473       return;
10474     }
10475 
10476   /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10477      the location.  */
10478 
10479   rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10480   if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10481     {
10482       add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10483       return;
10484     }
10485 
10486   /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10487      didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10488      location list, try generating a location from that.  */
10489   if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10490     {
10491       node = loc_list->first;
10492       descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10493       if (descr)
10494 	{
10495 	  add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10496 	  return;
10497 	}
10498     }
10499 
10500   /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10501      description from the tree.  */
10502   descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10503   if (descr)
10504     {
10505       add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10506       return;
10507     }
10508   /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10509      try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL.  */
10510   tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10511 }
10512 
10513 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10514    as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10515    we should tell the debugger about the constant value.  */
10516 
10517 static void
tree_add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref var_die,tree decl)10518 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10519 {
10520   tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10521   tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10522   rtx rtl;
10523 
10524   if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10525     /* OK */;
10526   else
10527     return;
10528 
10529   rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10530   if (rtl)
10531     add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10532 }
10533 
10534 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10535    location list.  This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10536    a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10537    DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10538    expressions.  */
10539 
10540 static dw_loc_list_ref
convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10541 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10542 {
10543   dw_fde_ref fde;
10544   dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10545   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10546   dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10547   const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10548 
10549   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10550 
10551   section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10552   list_tail = &list;
10553   list = NULL;
10554 
10555   next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10556   next_cfa.offset = 0;
10557   next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10558   next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10559 
10560   start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10561 
10562   /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10563      advance opcodes.  */
10564   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10565     lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10566 
10567   last_cfa = next_cfa;
10568   last_label = start_label;
10569 
10570   for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10571     switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10572       {
10573       case DW_CFA_set_loc:
10574       case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10575       case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10576       case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10577 	if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10578 	  {
10579 	    *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10580 				       start_label, last_label, section,
10581 				       list == NULL);
10582 
10583 	    list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10584 	    last_cfa = next_cfa;
10585 	    start_label = last_label;
10586 	  }
10587 	last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10588 	break;
10589 
10590       case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10591 	/* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this.  */
10592       case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10593       case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10594 	/* We don't handle these two in this function.  It would be possible
10595 	   if it were to be required.  */
10596 	gcc_unreachable ();
10597 
10598       default:
10599 	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10600 	break;
10601       }
10602 
10603   if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10604     {
10605       *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10606 				 start_label, last_label, section,
10607 				 list == NULL);
10608       list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10609       start_label = last_label;
10610     }
10611   *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10612 			     start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10613 			     list == NULL);
10614 
10615   return list;
10616 }
10617 
10618 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10619    frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10620    frame_pointer_fb_offset.  OFFSET is added to the displacement
10621    before the latter is negated.  */
10622 
10623 static void
compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10624 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10625 {
10626   rtx reg, elim;
10627 
10628 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10629   reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10630   offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10631 #else
10632   reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10633   offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10634 #endif
10635 
10636   elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10637   if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10638     {
10639       offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10640       elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10641     }
10642   gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10643 		       : stack_pointer_rtx));
10644 
10645   frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10646 }
10647 
10648 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10649    the value of the attribute.  */
10650 
10651 static void
add_name_attribute(dw_die_ref die,const char * name_string)10652 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10653 {
10654   if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10655     {
10656       if (demangle_name_func)
10657 	name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10658 
10659       add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10660     }
10661 }
10662 
10663 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE.  */
10664 
10665 static void
add_comp_dir_attribute(dw_die_ref die)10666 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10667 {
10668   const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10669   if (wd != NULL)
10670     add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10671 }
10672 
10673 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10674    a representation for that bound.  */
10675 
10676 static void
add_bound_info(dw_die_ref subrange_die,enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,tree bound)10677 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10678 {
10679   switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10680     {
10681     case ERROR_MARK:
10682       return;
10683 
10684     /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes.  */
10685     case INTEGER_CST:
10686       if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10687 	  || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10688 	      && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) &&  integer_zerop (bound))
10689 		  || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10690 	/* Use the default.  */
10691 	;
10692       else
10693 	add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10694       break;
10695 
10696     case CONVERT_EXPR:
10697     case NOP_EXPR:
10698     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10699     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10700       add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10701       break;
10702 
10703     case SAVE_EXPR:
10704       break;
10705 
10706     case VAR_DECL:
10707     case PARM_DECL:
10708     case RESULT_DECL:
10709       {
10710 	dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10711 
10712 	/* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10713 	   first?  Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10714 	   the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10715 	   the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10716 	   later parameter.  */
10717 	if (decl_die != NULL)
10718 	  add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10719 	break;
10720       }
10721 
10722     default:
10723       {
10724 	/* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10725 	   evaluate the value of the array bound.  */
10726 
10727 	dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10728 	dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10729 
10730 	loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10731 	if (loc == NULL)
10732 	  break;
10733 
10734 	if (current_function_decl == 0)
10735 	  ctx = comp_unit_die;
10736 	else
10737 	  ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10738 
10739 	decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10740 	add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10741 	add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10742 	add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10743 
10744 	add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10745 	break;
10746       }
10747     }
10748 }
10749 
10750 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10751    includes information about the element type of type given array type.  */
10752 
10753 static void
add_subscript_info(dw_die_ref type_die,tree type)10754 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10755 {
10756 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10757   unsigned dimension_number;
10758 #endif
10759   tree lower, upper;
10760   dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10761 
10762   /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10763      one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10764      types.  Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10765      type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10766      Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10767      compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10768      arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10769      (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this.  */
10770 
10771   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10772      const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10773      We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
10774      gen_array_type_die.  */
10775 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10776   for (dimension_number = 0;
10777        TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10778        type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10779 #endif
10780     {
10781       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10782 
10783       /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10784 	 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds.  Handle all three forms
10785 	 here.  */
10786       subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10787       if (domain)
10788 	{
10789 	  /* We have an array type with specified bounds.  */
10790 	  lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10791 	  upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10792 
10793 	  /* Define the index type.  */
10794 	  if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10795 	    {
10796 	      /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type.  Ignore the
10797 		 TREE_TYPE field.  We can't emit debug info for this
10798 		 because it is an unnamed integral type.  */
10799 	      if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10800 		  && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10801 		  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10802 		  && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10803 		;
10804 	      else
10805 		add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10806 				    type_die);
10807 	    }
10808 
10809 	  /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10810 	     but it does have a lower bound.  This happens with Fortran
10811 	       dimension arr(N:*)
10812 	     Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10813 	     to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10814 	     bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope.  */
10815 
10816 	  add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10817 	  if (upper)
10818 	    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10819 	}
10820 
10821       /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length.  The
10822 	 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10823 	 bounds.  */
10824     }
10825 }
10826 
10827 static void
add_byte_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree tree_node)10828 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10829 {
10830   unsigned size;
10831 
10832   switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10833     {
10834     case ERROR_MARK:
10835       size = 0;
10836       break;
10837     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10838     case RECORD_TYPE:
10839     case UNION_TYPE:
10840     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10841       size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10842       break;
10843     case FIELD_DECL:
10844       /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10845 	 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10846 	 object of the *declared* type of the member itself.  This is true
10847 	 even for bit-fields.  */
10848       size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10849       break;
10850     default:
10851       gcc_unreachable ();
10852     }
10853 
10854   /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point.  If it is, that
10855      indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable.  We
10856      have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time.
10857      GCC/35998: Avoid passing negative sizes to Dtrace and gdb.  */
10858   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, (size != (unsigned)-1 ? size : 0));
10859 }
10860 
10861 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10862    which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10863    "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10864    bit-field itself.
10865 
10866    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10867    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
10868    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10869    declared type of the individual bit-field itself.  The determination of the
10870    exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10871    complicated.  It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10872 
10873    Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10874    which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10875    (See `byte_size_attribute' above).  */
10876 
10877 static inline void
add_bit_offset_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10878 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10879 {
10880   HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10881   tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10882   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10883   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10884   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10885   HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10886 
10887   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10888   gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10889 
10890   /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10891      encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10892      whatsoever.  Likewise for variable or too large size.  */
10893   if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10894       || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10895     return;
10896 
10897   bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10898 
10899   /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10900      highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10901      the bit-field itself.  Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10902      is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10903      below must take account of these differences.  */
10904   highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10905   highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10906 
10907   if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10908     {
10909       highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10910       highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10911     }
10912 
10913   bit_offset
10914     = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10915        ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10916        : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10917 
10918   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10919 }
10920 
10921 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10922    which specifies the length in bits of the given field.  */
10923 
10924 static inline void
add_bit_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10925 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10926 {
10927   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10928   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10929 	      && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10930 
10931   if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10932     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10933 }
10934 
10935 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10936    attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function.  */
10937 
10938 static inline void
add_prototyped_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_type)10939 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10940 {
10941   if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10942       && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10943     add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10944 }
10945 
10946 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE.  The DIE is found
10947    by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10948    equate table.  */
10949 
10950 static inline void
add_abstract_origin_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree origin)10951 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10952 {
10953   dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10954 
10955   if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10956     {
10957       /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10958 	 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10959 	 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10960 
10961 	 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10962 	 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline.  */
10963       tree fn = origin;
10964 
10965       if (TYPE_P (fn))
10966 	fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10967 
10968       fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10969       if (fn)
10970 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10971     }
10972 
10973   if (DECL_P (origin))
10974     origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10975   else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10976     origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10977 
10978   /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10979      trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10980      languages).  For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10981      output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases.  Rather
10982      than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10983      have variables without a proper abstract origin.  In the future, when all
10984      functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10985      here.  */
10986 
10987   if (origin_die)
10988       add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10989 }
10990 
10991 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute.  */
10992 
10993 static inline void
add_pure_or_virtual_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_decl)10994 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10995 {
10996   if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10997     {
10998       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10999 
11000       if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
11001 	add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
11002 		    new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
11003 				   tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
11004 				   0));
11005 
11006       /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally.  */
11007       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11008 	add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11009 			lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
11010     }
11011 }
11012 
11013 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl.  */
11014 
11015 static void
add_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11016 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11017 {
11018   expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11019 
11020   add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
11021   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11022 }
11023 
11024 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11025    given decl, but only if it actually has a name.  */
11026 
11027 static void
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11028 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11029 {
11030   tree decl_name;
11031 
11032   decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
11033   if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
11034     {
11035       add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
11036       if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11037 	add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
11038 
11039       if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11040 	  && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11041 	  && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11042 	  && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11043 	  && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
11044 	add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11045 		       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11046     }
11047 
11048 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11049   /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL.  This may be different
11050      from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11051   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11052     {
11053       add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11054 		   XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11055       VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11056     }
11057 #endif
11058 }
11059 
11060 /* Push a new declaration scope.  */
11061 
11062 static void
push_decl_scope(tree scope)11063 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11064 {
11065   VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11066 }
11067 
11068 /* Pop a declaration scope.  */
11069 
11070 static inline void
pop_decl_scope(void)11071 pop_decl_scope (void)
11072 {
11073   VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11074 }
11075 
11076 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11077    Non-named types get global scope.  Named types nested in other
11078    types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11079    otherwise.  All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11080    the current active scope.  */
11081 
11082 static dw_die_ref
scope_die_for(tree t,dw_die_ref context_die)11083 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11084 {
11085   dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11086   tree containing_scope;
11087   int i;
11088 
11089   /* Non-types always go in the current scope.  */
11090   gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11091 
11092   containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11093 
11094   /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration).  */
11095   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11096     {
11097       if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11098 	/* OK */;
11099       else
11100 	containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11101     }
11102 
11103   /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend.  They mean that
11104      a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11105      that isn't useful to DWARF.  */
11106   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11107     containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11108 
11109   if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11110     scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11111   else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11112     {
11113       /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE.  But
11114 	 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11115 	 so we know where the new DIE should go.  */
11116       for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11117 	if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11118 	  break;
11119 
11120       if (i < 0)
11121 	{
11122 	  gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11123 		      || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11124 
11125 	  /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope.  */
11126 	  scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11127 	}
11128       else
11129 	scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11130     }
11131   else
11132     scope_die = context_die;
11133 
11134   return scope_die;
11135 }
11136 
11137 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function.  */
11138 
11139 static inline int
local_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11140 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11141 {
11142   for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11143     if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11144 	|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11145       return 1;
11146 
11147   return 0;
11148 }
11149 
11150 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11151    whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration.  */
11152 
11153 static inline int
class_or_namespace_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11154 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11155 {
11156   return (context_die
11157 	  && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11158 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11159 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11160 }
11161 
11162 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute.  This
11163    routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11164    by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die.  */
11165 
11166 static void
add_type_attribute(dw_die_ref object_die,tree type,int decl_const,int decl_volatile,dw_die_ref context_die)11167 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11168 		    int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11169 {
11170   enum tree_code code  = TREE_CODE (type);
11171   dw_die_ref type_die  = NULL;
11172 
11173   /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11174      floating-point type, use the inner type.  This is because we have no
11175      support for unnamed types in base_type_die.  This can happen if this is
11176      an Ada subrange type.  Correct solution is emit a subrange type die.  */
11177   if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11178       && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11179     type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11180 
11181   if (code == ERROR_MARK
11182       /* Handle a special case.  For functions whose return type is void, we
11183 	 generate *no* type attribute.  (Note that no object may have type
11184 	 `void', so this only applies to function return types).  */
11185       || code == VOID_TYPE)
11186     return;
11187 
11188   type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11189 				decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11190 				decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11191 				context_die);
11192 
11193   if (type_die != NULL)
11194     add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11195 }
11196 
11197 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11198    function call type.  */
11199 static void
add_calling_convention_attribute(dw_die_ref subr_die,tree type)11200 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11201 {
11202   enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11203 
11204   value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11205 
11206   /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11207      is not DW_CC_normal.  */
11208   if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11209     add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11210 }
11211 
11212 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11213    a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11214    was declared without a tag.  */
11215 
11216 static const char *
type_tag(tree type)11217 type_tag (tree type)
11218 {
11219   const char *name = 0;
11220 
11221   if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11222     {
11223       tree t = 0;
11224 
11225       /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name.  */
11226       if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11227 	t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11228 
11229       /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11230 	 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11231 	 involved.  */
11232       else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11233 	       && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11234 	t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11235 
11236       /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one.  */
11237       if (t != 0)
11238 	name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11239     }
11240 
11241   return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11242 }
11243 
11244 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11245    for bit field types.  */
11246 
11247 static inline tree
member_declared_type(tree member)11248 member_declared_type (tree member)
11249 {
11250   return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11251 	  ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11252 }
11253 
11254 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11255    from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11256 
11257 #if 0
11258 static const char *
11259 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11260 {
11261   rtx x;
11262   const char *fnname;
11263 
11264   x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11265   gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11266 
11267   x = XEXP (x, 0);
11268   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11269 
11270   fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11271   return fnname;
11272 }
11273 #endif
11274 
11275 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11276    the compilation unit.  Debugging information is collected by walking
11277    the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl().  */
11278 
11279 static void
gen_array_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11280 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11281 {
11282   dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11283   dw_die_ref array_die;
11284   tree element_type;
11285 
11286   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11287      the inner array type comes before the outer array type.  Thus we must
11288      call gen_type_die before we call new_die.  See below also.  */
11289 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11290   gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11291 #endif
11292 
11293   array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11294   add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11295   equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11296 
11297   if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11298     {
11299       /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11300 	 containing an array.  Pull out the array type.  */
11301       type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11302       add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11303     }
11304 
11305 #if 0
11306   /* We default the array ordering.  SDB will probably do
11307      the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present.  It's not even
11308      an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway.  If
11309      SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11310      then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in.  (But if
11311      and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11312      for multidimensional arrays.  */
11313   add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11314 #endif
11315 
11316 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11317   /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11318      AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs.  */
11319   if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11320     add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11321   else
11322 #endif
11323     add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11324 
11325   /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type.  */
11326   element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11327 
11328   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11329      const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11330      We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
11331      add_subscript_info.  */
11332 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11333   while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11334     element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11335 
11336   gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11337 #endif
11338 
11339   add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11340 
11341   if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
11342     add_pubtype (type, array_die);
11343 }
11344 
11345 #if 0
11346 static void
11347 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11348 {
11349   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11350   dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11351 
11352   if (origin != NULL)
11353     add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11354   else
11355     {
11356       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11357       add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11358 			  0, 0, context_die);
11359     }
11360 
11361   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11362     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11363   else
11364     add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11365 }
11366 #endif
11367 
11368 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11369    emit full debugging info for them.  */
11370 
11371 static void
retry_incomplete_types(void)11372 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11373 {
11374   int i;
11375 
11376   for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11377     gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11378 }
11379 
11380 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type.  */
11381 
11382 static void
gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11383 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11384 {
11385   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11386 
11387   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11388      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11389   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11390 }
11391 
11392 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type.  */
11393 
11394 static void
gen_inlined_structure_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11395 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11396 {
11397   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11398 
11399   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11400      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11401   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11402 }
11403 
11404 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type.  */
11405 
11406 static void
gen_inlined_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11407 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11408 {
11409   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11410 
11411   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11412      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11413   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11414 }
11415 
11416 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type.  Note that these DIEs
11417    include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11418    enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11419    DIE.  */
11420 
11421 static dw_die_ref
gen_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11422 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11423 {
11424   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11425 
11426   if (type_die == NULL)
11427     {
11428       type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11429 			  scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11430       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11431       add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11432     }
11433   else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11434     return type_die;
11435   else
11436     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11437 
11438   /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types.  If the
11439      given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11440      attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute.  */
11441   if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11442     {
11443       tree link;
11444 
11445       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11446       add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11447       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11448 	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11449 
11450       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11451 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
11452       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11453 	add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11454 
11455       for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11456 	   link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11457 	{
11458 	  dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11459 	  tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11460 
11461 	  add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11462 			      IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11463 
11464 	  if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11465 	    /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11466 	       not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned.  GDB
11467 	       always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11468 	       values as if they were signed.  That means that
11469 	       enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11470 	       will appear to have negative values in the debugger.  */
11471 	    add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11472 			tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11473 	}
11474     }
11475   else
11476     add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11477 
11478   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
11479     add_pubtype (type, type_die);
11480 
11481   return type_die;
11482 }
11483 
11484 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11485    represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11486    type.
11487 
11488    Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11489    ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11490    represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11491    node.  If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11492    DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof).  If
11493    it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11494    DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11495    argument type of some subprogram type.  */
11496 
11497 static dw_die_ref
gen_formal_parameter_die(tree node,dw_die_ref context_die)11498 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11499 {
11500   dw_die_ref parm_die
11501     = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11502   tree origin;
11503 
11504   switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11505     {
11506     case tcc_declaration:
11507       origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11508       if (origin != NULL)
11509 	add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11510       else
11511 	{
11512 	  add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11513 	  add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11514 			      TREE_READONLY (node),
11515 			      TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11516 			      context_die);
11517 	  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11518 	    add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11519 	}
11520 
11521       equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11522       if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11523 	add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11524 
11525       break;
11526 
11527     case tcc_type:
11528       /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node.  */
11529       add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11530       break;
11531 
11532     default:
11533       gcc_unreachable ();
11534     }
11535 
11536   return parm_die;
11537 }
11538 
11539 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11540    at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list.  */
11541 
11542 static void
gen_unspecified_parameters_die(tree decl_or_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11543 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11544 {
11545   new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11546 }
11547 
11548 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11549    DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11550    parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11551    those which appear as part of a function *definition*).  */
11552 
11553 static void
gen_formal_types_die(tree function_or_method_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11554 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11555 {
11556   tree link;
11557   tree formal_type = NULL;
11558   tree first_parm_type;
11559   tree arg;
11560 
11561   if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11562     {
11563       arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11564       function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11565     }
11566   else
11567     arg = NULL_TREE;
11568 
11569   first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11570 
11571   /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11572      DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one.  */
11573   for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11574     {
11575       dw_die_ref parm_die;
11576 
11577       formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11578       if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11579 	break;
11580 
11581       /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself.  */
11582       parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11583       if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11584 	   && link == first_parm_type)
11585 	  || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11586 	add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11587 
11588       link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11589       if (arg)
11590 	arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11591     }
11592 
11593   /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11594      DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list.  */
11595   if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11596     gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11597 
11598   /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11599      and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary).  */
11600   for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11601        link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11602        link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11603     gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11604 }
11605 
11606 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11607    die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11608    to the member declaration nested within TYPE.  If we're trying to
11609    generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11610    trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand.  */
11611 
11612 static void
gen_type_die_for_member(tree type,tree member,dw_die_ref context_die)11613 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11614 {
11615   gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11616 
11617   /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11618      emitted the member decl for this function.  Emit it now.  */
11619   if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11620       && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11621     {
11622       dw_die_ref type_die;
11623       gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11624 
11625       push_decl_scope (type);
11626       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11627       if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11628 	gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11629       else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11630 	{
11631 	  /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11632 	     C++ anonymous unions and structs.  */
11633 	  if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11634 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11635 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11636 	    {
11637 	      gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11638 	      gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11639 	    }
11640 	}
11641       else
11642 	gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11643 
11644       pop_decl_scope ();
11645     }
11646 }
11647 
11648 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11649    may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of.  */
11650 
11651 static void
dwarf2out_abstract_function(tree decl)11652 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11653 {
11654   dw_die_ref old_die;
11655   tree save_fn;
11656   struct function *save_cfun;
11657   tree context;
11658   int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11659 
11660   /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone.  */
11661   decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11662 
11663   old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11664   if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11665     /* We've already generated the abstract instance.  */
11666     return;
11667 
11668   /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11669      we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT.  */
11670   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11671     {
11672       context = decl_class_context (decl);
11673       if (context)
11674 	gen_type_die_for_member
11675 	  (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11676     }
11677 
11678   /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function.  */
11679   save_fn = current_function_decl;
11680   save_cfun = cfun;
11681   current_function_decl = decl;
11682   cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11683 
11684   set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11685   dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11686   if (! was_abstract)
11687     set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11688 
11689   current_function_decl = save_fn;
11690   cfun = save_cfun;
11691 }
11692 
11693 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11694    htab_traverse_resize().
11695 
11696    Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11697    marked as unused by prune_unused_types.  */
11698 static int
premark_used_types_helper(void ** slot,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11699 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11700 {
11701   tree type;
11702   dw_die_ref die;
11703 
11704   type = *slot;
11705   die = lookup_type_die (type);
11706   if (die != NULL)
11707     die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11708   return 1;
11709 }
11710 
11711 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial.  */
11712 static void
premark_used_types(void)11713 premark_used_types (void)
11714 {
11715   if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11716     htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11717 }
11718 
11719 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11720    block-local).  */
11721 
11722 static void
gen_subprogram_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)11723 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11724 {
11725   char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11726   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11727   dw_die_ref subr_die;
11728   tree fn_arg_types;
11729   tree outer_scope;
11730   dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11731   int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11732 		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11733 
11734   premark_used_types ();
11735 
11736   /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11737      started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11738      its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11739      from the member list for the class.  If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11740      we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class.  */
11741 
11742   /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE.  */
11743   if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11744     {
11745       origin = NULL;
11746       gcc_assert (!old_die);
11747     }
11748 
11749   /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11750      might need to retrofit the declaration into its class.  */
11751   if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11752       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11753       && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11754       && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11755     old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11756 
11757   if (origin != NULL)
11758     {
11759       gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11760 
11761       /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11762 	 inline function.  */
11763       if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11764 	add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11765 
11766       subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11767       add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11768     }
11769   else if (old_die)
11770     {
11771       expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11772       struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11773 
11774       if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11775 	  /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11776 	     case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11777 	     It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case.  */
11778 	  && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11779 	{
11780 	  /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11781 	     something we have already output.  */
11782 	  return;
11783 	}
11784 
11785       /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11786 	 maybe use the old DIE.  We always want the DIE for this function
11787 	 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11788 	 debugger can find it.  We also need to do this for abstract
11789 	 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11790 	 to have the same parent.  For local class methods, this doesn't
11791 	 apply; we just use the old DIE.  */
11792       if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11793 	  && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11794 	      || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11795 		  && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11796 		      == (unsigned) s.line))))
11797 	{
11798 	  subr_die = old_die;
11799 
11800 	  /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11801 	     Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11802 	     declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11803 	     cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11804 	     is one of the children that we do not want to remove.  */
11805 	  remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11806 	  remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11807 	}
11808       else
11809 	{
11810 	  subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11811 	  add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11812 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11813 	    add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11814 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
11815 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11816 	}
11817     }
11818   else
11819     {
11820       subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11821 
11822       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11823 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11824 
11825       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11826       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11827 	{
11828 	  add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11829 	  add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11830 			      0, 0, context_die);
11831 	}
11832 
11833       add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11834       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11835 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11836 
11837       if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11838 	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11839       else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11840 	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11841     }
11842 
11843   if (declaration)
11844     {
11845       if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11846 	{
11847 	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11848 
11849 	  /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11850 	     the class to which it belongs.  We make sure of this by emitting
11851 	     the class first.  The next time is the definition, which is
11852 	     handled above.  The two may come from the same source text.
11853 
11854 	     Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11855 	     later reused to represent definition.  */
11856 	  equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11857 	}
11858     }
11859   else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11860     {
11861       if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11862 	{
11863           if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11864 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11865 	  else
11866 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11867 	}
11868       else
11869 	{
11870 	  if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11871             add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11872 	  else
11873             add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11874 	}
11875 
11876       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11877     }
11878   else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11879     {
11880       HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11881 
11882       if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11883 	equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11884 
11885       if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11886 	{
11887 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11888 				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11889 	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11890 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11891 				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11892 	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11893 
11894 	  add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11895 	  add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11896 	}
11897       else
11898 	{  /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11899 	      hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11900 	      section begin/end labels to generate the aranges...  */
11901 	  /*
11902 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11903 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11904 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11905 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11906 
11907 	    add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11908 	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11909 	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11910 	   */
11911 	}
11912 
11913 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11914       /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine.  */
11915       add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11916 #endif
11917 
11918       cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11919 
11920       /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA.  This is more
11921 	 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11922 	 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11923 	 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11924 	 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11925 	 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11926 	 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11927 	 function.  */
11928       /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11929 	 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  At present there are no dwarf
11930 	 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11931 	 convert the CFA data into a location list.  */
11932       {
11933 	dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11934 	if (list->dw_loc_next)
11935 	  add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11936 	else
11937 	  add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11938       }
11939 
11940       /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11941 	 the CFA.  The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11942 	 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11943 	 debugger about.  We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11944 	 by this displacement.  */
11945       compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11946 
11947       if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11948 	add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11949 		 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11950     }
11951 
11952   /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11953      (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11954      for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11955      `...' at the end of the formal parameter list.  In order to find out if
11956      there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11957      associated with the FUNCTION_DECL.  This will be a node of type
11958      FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11959      FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11960      an ellipsis at the end.  */
11961 
11962   /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11963      need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11964      its formal parameters.  */
11965   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11966     ;
11967   else if (declaration)
11968     gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11969   else
11970     {
11971       /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters.  */
11972       tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11973       tree parm;
11974 
11975       /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11976 	 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11977       for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11978 	if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11979 	  {
11980 	    if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11981 		&& !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11982 			    "__builtin_va_alist"))
11983 	      gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11984 	    else
11985 	      gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11986 	  }
11987 
11988       /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11989 	 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11990 	 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11991 	 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11992 	 definition).  This just means that we have no info about the
11993 	 parameters at all.  */
11994       fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11995       if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11996 	{
11997 	  /* This is the prototyped case, check for....  */
11998 	  if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11999 	    gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12000 	}
12001       else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
12002 	gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12003     }
12004 
12005   /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
12006      (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).  */
12007   outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
12008 
12009   /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12010      a function.  This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12011      for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12012      parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12013      end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12014      the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12015      DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12016 
12017      The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12018      the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12019      for those in decls_for_scope.  Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12020      a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12021      and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12022      constructor function.  */
12023   if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
12024     {
12025       /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value.  */
12026       if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
12027 	gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
12028 
12029       current_function_has_inlines = 0;
12030       decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
12031 
12032 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12033       if (current_function_has_inlines)
12034 	{
12035 	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12036 	  if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
12037 	    {
12038 	      add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12039 	      comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
12040 	    }
12041 	}
12042 #endif
12043     }
12044   /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested.  */
12045   add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12046 
12047 }
12048 
12049 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.  */
12050 
12051 static void
gen_variable_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12052 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12053 {
12054   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12055   dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12056 
12057   dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12058   int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12059 		     /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12060 			emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12061 			might end up being no definition anywhere in
12062 			the program.  For example, consider the C++
12063 			test case:
12064 
12065                           template <class T>
12066                           struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12067 
12068                           template <class T>
12069                           const int S<T>::i;
12070 
12071                           int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12072 
12073 			Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12074 			definition is required, so the compiler will
12075 			not emit a definition.  */
12076 		     || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12077 			 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12078 		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12079 
12080   if (origin != NULL)
12081     add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12082 
12083   /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12084      static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12085 
12086      ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12087      copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12088      sharing them.
12089 
12090      ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12091 
12092      ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12093      variable, both of which are declarations.  We want to avoid considering
12094      one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12095      declaration.  */
12096   else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12097 	   && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12098     {
12099       /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static.  */
12100       add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12101       if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12102 	{
12103 	  expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12104 	  struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12105 
12106 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12107 	    add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12108 
12109 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12110 
12111 	    add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12112 	}
12113     }
12114   else
12115     {
12116       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12117       add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12118 			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12119 
12120       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12121 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12122 
12123       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12124 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12125 
12126       if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12127 	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12128       else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12129 	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12130     }
12131 
12132   if (declaration)
12133     add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12134 
12135   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12136     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12137 
12138   if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12139     {
12140       add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12141       add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12142     }
12143   else
12144     tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12145 }
12146 
12147 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier.  */
12148 
12149 static void
gen_label_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12150 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12151 {
12152   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12153   dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12154   rtx insn;
12155   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12156 
12157   if (origin != NULL)
12158     add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12159   else
12160     add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12161 
12162   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12163     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12164   else
12165     {
12166       insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12167 
12168       /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12169 	 eliminated because of various optimizations.  We still emit them
12170 	 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them.  */
12171       if (insn
12172 	  && (LABEL_P (insn)
12173 	      || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12174 	           && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12175 	{
12176 	  /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12177 	     (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12178 	     represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12179 	     the user.  This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12180 	     it if it ever does happen.  */
12181 	  gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12182 
12183 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12184 	  add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12185 	}
12186     }
12187 }
12188 
12189 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die.  Add source coordinate
12190    attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12191    function was called from.  This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes.  */
12192 
12193 static inline void
add_call_src_coords_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12194 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12195 {
12196   expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12197 
12198   add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12199   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12200 }
12201 
12202 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12203    Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT.  */
12204 
12205 static inline void
add_high_low_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12206 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12207 {
12208   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12209 
12210   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12211     {
12212       tree chain;
12213 
12214       add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12215 
12216       chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12217       do
12218 	{
12219 	  add_ranges (chain);
12220 	  chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12221 	}
12222       while (chain);
12223       add_ranges (NULL);
12224     }
12225   else
12226     {
12227       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12228 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12229       add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12230       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12231 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12232       add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12233     }
12234 }
12235 
12236 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block.  */
12237 
12238 static void
gen_lexical_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12239 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12240 {
12241   dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12242 
12243   if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12244     add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12245 
12246   decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12247 }
12248 
12249 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram.  */
12250 
12251 static void
gen_inlined_subroutine_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12252 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12253 {
12254   tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12255 
12256   /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet.  We
12257      must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12258      emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12259      a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing.  */
12260   dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12261 
12262   if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12263     {
12264       dw_die_ref subr_die
12265 	= new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12266 
12267       add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12268       add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12269       add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12270 
12271       decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12272       current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12273     }
12274   else
12275     /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12276        inlined into function B that was inlined into function C.  When
12277        generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12278        would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12279        So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12280        for this one.  Instead, just emit debugging info for
12281        declarations within the block.  This is particularly important
12282        in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12283        if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12284        wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12285        when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12286        intended :-)  */
12287     gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12288 }
12289 
12290 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure.  */
12291 
12292 static void
gen_field_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12293 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12294 {
12295   dw_die_ref decl_die;
12296 
12297   if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12298     return;
12299 
12300   decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12301   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12302   add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12303 		      TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12304 		      context_die);
12305 
12306   if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12307     {
12308       add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12309       add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12310       add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12311     }
12312 
12313   if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12314     add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12315 
12316   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12317     add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12318 
12319   if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12320     add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12321   else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12322     add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12323 
12324   /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on.  */
12325   equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12326 }
12327 
12328 #if 0
12329 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12330    Use modified_type_die instead.
12331    We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12332    represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12333 
12334 static void
12335 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12336 {
12337   dw_die_ref ptr_die
12338     = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12339 
12340   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12341   add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12342   add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12343 }
12344 
12345 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12346    Use modified_type_die instead.
12347    We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12348    represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12349 
12350 static void
12351 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12352 {
12353   dw_die_ref ref_die
12354     = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12355 
12356   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12357   add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12358   add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12359 }
12360 #endif
12361 
12362 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type.  */
12363 
12364 static void
gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12365 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12366 {
12367   dw_die_ref ptr_die
12368     = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12369 	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12370 
12371   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12372   add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12373 		  lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12374   add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12375 }
12376 
12377 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit.  */
12378 
12379 static dw_die_ref
gen_compile_unit_die(const char * filename)12380 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12381 {
12382   dw_die_ref die;
12383   char producer[250];
12384   const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12385   int language;
12386 
12387   die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12388 
12389   if (filename)
12390     {
12391       add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12392       /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>.  */
12393       if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12394 	add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12395     }
12396 
12397   sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12398 
12399 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12400   /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12401      string.  The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12402      not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12403      that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12404      To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12405      information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string.  */
12406   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12407     strcat (producer, " -g");
12408 #endif
12409 
12410   add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12411 
12412   if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12413     language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12414   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12415     language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12416   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12417     language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12418   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12419     language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12420   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12421     language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12422   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12423     language = DW_LANG_Java;
12424   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12425     language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12426   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12427     language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12428   else
12429     language = DW_LANG_C89;
12430 
12431   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12432   return die;
12433 }
12434 
12435 /* Generate the DIE for a base class.  */
12436 
12437 static void
gen_inheritance_die(tree binfo,tree access,dw_die_ref context_die)12438 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12439 {
12440   dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12441 
12442   add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12443   add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12444 
12445   if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12446     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12447 
12448   if (access == access_public_node)
12449     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12450   else if (access == access_protected_node)
12451     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12452 }
12453 
12454 /* Generate a DIE for a class member.  */
12455 
12456 static void
gen_member_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12457 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12458 {
12459   tree member;
12460   tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12461   dw_die_ref child;
12462 
12463   /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12464      members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12465      members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12466      DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12467      function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12468      types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12469      for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12470      members of this (containing) type themselves.  The g++ front- end can
12471      force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12472      type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12473      the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type.  */
12474 
12475   /* First output info about the base classes.  */
12476   if (binfo)
12477     {
12478       VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12479       int i;
12480       tree base;
12481 
12482       for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12483 	gen_inheritance_die (base,
12484 			     (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12485 			      : access_public_node), context_die);
12486     }
12487 
12488   /* Now output info about the data members and type members.  */
12489   for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12490     {
12491       /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12492 	 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12493 	 may have already been defined.  Don't define them again, but
12494 	 do put them in the right order.  */
12495 
12496       child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12497       if (child)
12498 	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12499       else
12500 	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12501     }
12502 
12503   /* Now output info about the function members (if any).  */
12504   for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12505     {
12506       /* Don't include clones in the member list.  */
12507       if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12508 	continue;
12509 
12510       child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12511       if (child)
12512 	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12513       else
12514 	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12515     }
12516 }
12517 
12518 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type.  If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12519    is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12520    member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs.  */
12521 
12522 static void
gen_struct_or_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12523 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12524 				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12525 {
12526   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12527   dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12528   int nested = 0;
12529   int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12530 		  && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12531 		      || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12532   int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12533   complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
12534 
12535   if (type_die && ! complete)
12536     return;
12537 
12538   if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12539       && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12540 	  || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12541     nested = 1;
12542 
12543   scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12544 
12545   if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12546     /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class.  */
12547     {
12548       dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12549 
12550       type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12551 			  ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12552 			  scope_die, type);
12553       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12554       if (old_die)
12555 	add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12556       else
12557 	add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12558     }
12559   else
12560     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12561 
12562   /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12563      then give a list of members.  */
12564   if (complete && !ns_decl)
12565     {
12566       /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12567 	 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself.  */
12568       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12569       add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12570       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12571 	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12572 
12573       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12574 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
12575       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12576 	add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12577 
12578       push_decl_scope (type);
12579       gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12580       pop_decl_scope ();
12581 
12582       /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in.  */
12583       if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12584 	{
12585 	  tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12586 
12587 	  gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12588 	  add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12589 			  lookup_type_die (vtype));
12590 	}
12591     }
12592   else
12593     {
12594       add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12595 
12596       /* We don't need to do this for function-local types.  */
12597       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12598 	  && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12599 	VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12600     }
12601 
12602   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12603     add_pubtype (type, type_die);
12604 }
12605 
12606 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_.  */
12607 
12608 static void
gen_subroutine_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12609 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12610 {
12611   tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12612   dw_die_ref subr_die
12613     = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12614 	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12615 
12616   equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12617   add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12618   add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12619   gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12620 
12621   if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
12622     add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
12623 }
12624 
12625 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition.  */
12626 
12627 static void
gen_typedef_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12628 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12629 {
12630   dw_die_ref type_die;
12631   tree origin;
12632 
12633   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12634     return;
12635 
12636   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12637   type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12638   origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12639   if (origin != NULL)
12640     add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12641   else
12642     {
12643       tree type;
12644 
12645       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12646       if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12647 	{
12648 	  type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12649 
12650 	  gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12651 	  equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12652 	}
12653       else
12654 	type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12655 
12656       add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12657 			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12658     }
12659 
12660   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12661     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12662 
12663   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12664     add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
12665 }
12666 
12667 /* Generate a type description DIE.  */
12668 
12669 static void
gen_type_die_with_usage(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12670 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12671 				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12672 {
12673   int need_pop;
12674 
12675   if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12676     return;
12677 
12678   if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12679       && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12680     {
12681       if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12682 	return;
12683 
12684       /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type.  */
12685       gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12686 
12687       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12688       gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12689       return;
12690     }
12691 
12692   /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12693      of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12694      get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12695      now.  (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12696      cloned type itself).  */
12697   if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12698     type = type_main_variant (type);
12699 
12700   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12701     return;
12702 
12703   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12704     {
12705     case ERROR_MARK:
12706       break;
12707 
12708     case POINTER_TYPE:
12709     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12710       /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type.  This
12711 	 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12712 	 type is recursive.  Recursive types are possible in Ada.  */
12713       /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12714 	 statement.  */
12715       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12716 
12717       /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12718 	 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type.  */
12719       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12720 				DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12721       break;
12722 
12723     case OFFSET_TYPE:
12724       /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12725 	 Output a description of the relevant class type.  */
12726       gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
12727 					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12728 
12729       /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to.  */
12730       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12731 					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12732 
12733       /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12734 	 itself.  */
12735       gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12736       break;
12737 
12738     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12739       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12740       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12741 					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12742       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12743       break;
12744 
12745     case METHOD_TYPE:
12746       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12747       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12748 					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12749       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12750       break;
12751 
12752     case ARRAY_TYPE:
12753       gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12754       break;
12755 
12756     case VECTOR_TYPE:
12757       gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12758       break;
12759 
12760     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12761     case RECORD_TYPE:
12762     case UNION_TYPE:
12763     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12764       /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12765 	 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too.  This does not apply
12766 	 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12767 	 the containing class as they are generated.  FIXME: This hurts the
12768 	 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12769 	 what set of template instantiations we'll get.  */
12770       if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12771 	  && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12772 	  && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12773 	{
12774 	  gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
12775 
12776 	  if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12777 	    return;
12778 
12779 	  /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub.  */
12780 	  push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12781 	  context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12782 	  need_pop = 1;
12783 	}
12784       else
12785 	{
12786 	  declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12787 	  need_pop = 0;
12788 	}
12789 
12790       if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12791 	{
12792 	  /* This might have been written out by the call to
12793 	     declare_in_namespace.  */
12794 	  if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12795 	    gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12796 	}
12797       else
12798 	gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
12799 
12800       if (need_pop)
12801 	pop_decl_scope ();
12802 
12803       /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12804 	 it up if it is ever completed.  gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12805 	 when appropriate.  */
12806       return;
12807 
12808     case VOID_TYPE:
12809     case INTEGER_TYPE:
12810     case REAL_TYPE:
12811     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12812     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12813       /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types.  */
12814       break;
12815 
12816     case LANG_TYPE:
12817       /* No Dwarf representation currently defined.  */
12818       break;
12819 
12820     default:
12821       gcc_unreachable ();
12822     }
12823 
12824   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12825 }
12826 
12827 static void
gen_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12828 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12829 {
12830   gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12831 }
12832 
12833 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation.  */
12834 
12835 static void
gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12836 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12837 {
12838   if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12839     return;
12840 
12841   /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12842      this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12843      that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12844      type now.  */
12845   gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12846 
12847   /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12848      an instance of an unresolved type.  */
12849 
12850   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12851     {
12852     case ERROR_MARK:
12853       break;
12854 
12855     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12856       gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12857       break;
12858 
12859     case RECORD_TYPE:
12860       gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12861       break;
12862 
12863     case UNION_TYPE:
12864     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12865       gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12866       break;
12867 
12868     default:
12869       gcc_unreachable ();
12870     }
12871 }
12872 
12873 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12874    things which are local to the given block.  */
12875 
12876 static void
gen_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12877 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12878 {
12879   int must_output_die = 0;
12880   tree origin;
12881   tree decl;
12882   enum tree_code origin_code;
12883 
12884   /* Ignore blocks that are NULL.  */
12885   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12886     return;
12887 
12888   /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12889      process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12890      origin block.  Do process subblocks.  */
12891   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12892     {
12893       tree sub;
12894 
12895       for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12896 	gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12897 
12898       return;
12899     }
12900 
12901   /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block.  This block may be an
12902      inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12903      to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12904      sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12905      the current block.  */
12906   origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12907   origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12908 
12909   /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12910      block.  */
12911   if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12912     /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented.  We
12913        generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them.  (See below.) */
12914     must_output_die = 1;
12915   else
12916     {
12917       /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12918 	 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12919 	 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12920 	 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12921 	 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules.  So we
12922 	 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12923 	 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag.  */
12924       if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12925 	{
12926 	  /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12927 	     local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for.  */
12928 	  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12929 	    /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12930 	       as being a "significant" one.  */
12931 	    must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12932 			       && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12933 				   || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12934 				   || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12935 	  else
12936 	    /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12937 	       definitions count as "significant" local declarations.  */
12938 	    for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12939 		 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12940 	      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12941 		  && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12942 		{
12943 		  must_output_die = 1;
12944 		  break;
12945 		}
12946 	}
12947     }
12948 
12949   /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12950      DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12951      all.  Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12952      needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12953      that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12954      local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12955      instances and local (nested) function definitions.  */
12956   if (must_output_die)
12957     {
12958       if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12959 	gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12960       else
12961 	gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12962     }
12963   else
12964     decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12965 }
12966 
12967 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12968    all of its sub-blocks.  */
12969 
12970 static void
decls_for_scope(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12971 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12972 {
12973   tree decl;
12974   tree subblocks;
12975 
12976   /* Ignore NULL blocks.  */
12977   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12978     return;
12979 
12980   if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12981     {
12982       /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12983 	 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12984 	 sub-blocks.  Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12985 	 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now.  */
12986       for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12987 	{
12988 	  dw_die_ref die;
12989 
12990 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12991 	    die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12992 	  else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12993 	    die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12994 	  else
12995 	    die = NULL;
12996 
12997 	  if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12998 	    add_child_die (context_die, die);
12999 	  /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
13000 	     these might be optimized out.  We are called for these later
13001 	     in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
13002 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
13003 	    ;
13004 	  else
13005 	    gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13006 	}
13007     }
13008 
13009   /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks.  */
13010   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13011     return;
13012 
13013   /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
13014      therein) of this block.  */
13015   for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
13016        subblocks != NULL;
13017        subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
13018     gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
13019 }
13020 
13021 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting?  */
13022 
13023 static inline int
is_redundant_typedef(tree decl)13024 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
13025 {
13026   if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13027     return 1;
13028 
13029   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
13030       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
13031       && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
13032       && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
13033       && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
13034     /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name.  */
13035     return 1;
13036 
13037   return 0;
13038 }
13039 
13040 /* Returns the DIE for decl.  A DIE will always be returned.  */
13041 
13042 static dw_die_ref
force_decl_die(tree decl)13043 force_decl_die (tree decl)
13044 {
13045   dw_die_ref decl_die;
13046   unsigned saved_external_flag;
13047   tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
13048   decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13049   if (!decl_die)
13050     {
13051       dw_die_ref context_die;
13052       tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13053       if (decl_context)
13054 	{
13055 	  /* Find die that represents this context.  */
13056 	  if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13057 	    context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13058 	  else
13059 	    context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13060 	}
13061       else
13062 	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13063 
13064       decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13065       if (decl_die)
13066 	return decl_die;
13067 
13068       switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13069 	{
13070 	case FUNCTION_DECL:
13071 	  /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13072 	     that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13073 	     declaration die.  */
13074 	  save_fn = current_function_decl;
13075 	  current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13076 	  gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13077 	  current_function_decl = save_fn;
13078 	  break;
13079 
13080 	case VAR_DECL:
13081 	  /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13082 	   gen_decl_die() call.  */
13083 	  saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13084 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13085 	  gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13086 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13087 	  break;
13088 
13089 	case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13090 	  dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13091 	  break;
13092 
13093 	default:
13094 	  gcc_unreachable ();
13095 	}
13096 
13097       /* We should be able to find the DIE now.  */
13098       if (!decl_die)
13099 	decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13100       gcc_assert (decl_die);
13101     }
13102 
13103   return decl_die;
13104 }
13105 
13106 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type.  A DIE is
13107    always returned.  */
13108 
13109 static dw_die_ref
force_type_die(tree type)13110 force_type_die (tree type)
13111 {
13112   dw_die_ref type_die;
13113 
13114   type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13115   if (!type_die)
13116     {
13117       dw_die_ref context_die;
13118       if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13119 	{
13120 	  if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13121 	    context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13122 	  else
13123 	    context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13124 	}
13125       else
13126 	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13127 
13128       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13129       if (type_die)
13130 	return type_die;
13131       gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13132       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13133       gcc_assert (type_die);
13134     }
13135   return type_die;
13136 }
13137 
13138 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13139    and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed.  */
13140 
13141 static dw_die_ref
setup_namespace_context(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13142 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13143 {
13144   tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13145 		  ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13146   if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13147     /* Force out the namespace.  */
13148     context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13149 
13150   return context_die;
13151 }
13152 
13153 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13154    type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13155 
13156    For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13157    declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope.  */
13158 
13159 static void
declare_in_namespace(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13160 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13161 {
13162   dw_die_ref ns_context;
13163 
13164   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13165     return;
13166 
13167   /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13168      namespace, as we will get confused.  It would have already been emitted
13169      when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways.  */
13170   if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
13171     return;
13172 
13173   ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
13174 
13175   if (ns_context != context_die)
13176     {
13177       if (DECL_P (thing))
13178 	gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
13179       else
13180 	gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
13181     }
13182 }
13183 
13184 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias.  */
13185 
13186 static void
gen_namespace_die(tree decl)13187 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
13188 {
13189   dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
13190 
13191   /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13192      they are an alias of.  */
13193   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
13194     {
13195       /* Output a real namespace.  */
13196       dw_die_ref namespace_die
13197 	= new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
13198       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13199       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13200     }
13201   else
13202     {
13203       /* Output a namespace alias.  */
13204 
13205       /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary.  */
13206       dw_die_ref origin_die
13207 	= force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13208 
13209       /* Now create the namespace alias DIE.  */
13210       dw_die_ref namespace_die
13211 	= new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13212       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13213       add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13214       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13215     }
13216 }
13217 
13218 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.  */
13219 
13220 static void
gen_decl_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)13221 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13222 {
13223   tree origin;
13224 
13225   if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13226     return;
13227 
13228   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13229     {
13230     case ERROR_MARK:
13231       break;
13232 
13233     case CONST_DECL:
13234       /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13235 	 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself.  */
13236       break;
13237 
13238     case FUNCTION_DECL:
13239       /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13240 	 unless they are class members or explicit block externs.  */
13241       if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13242 	  && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13243 	break;
13244 
13245 #if 0
13246       /* FIXME */
13247       /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13248 	 on local redeclarations of global functions.  That seems broken.  */
13249       if (current_function_decl != decl)
13250 	/* This is only a declaration.  */;
13251 #endif
13252 
13253       /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance.  */
13254       if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13255 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13256 
13257       /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13258 	 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it.  */
13259       else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13260 	       && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13261 	       && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13262 	       /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13263 		  a declaration.  We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13264 		  that case, because that works only if we have a die.  */
13265 	       && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13266 	{
13267 	  dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13268 	  set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13269 	}
13270 
13271       /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl.  */
13272       else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13273 	{
13274 	  /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13275 	     have described its return type.  */
13276 	  gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13277 
13278 	  /* And its virtual context.  */
13279 	  if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13280 	    gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13281 
13282 	  /* And its containing type.  */
13283 	  origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13284 	  if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13285 	    gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13286 
13287 	  /* And its containing namespace.  */
13288 	  declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13289 	}
13290 
13291       /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself.  */
13292       gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13293       break;
13294 
13295     case TYPE_DECL:
13296       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13297 	 actual typedefs.  */
13298       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13299 	break;
13300 
13301       /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13302 	 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13303 	 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13304 	 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13305 	 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13306 	 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here.  */
13307       if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE
13308 	  && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13309 	{
13310 	  gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13311 	  break;
13312 	}
13313 
13314       if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13315 	gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13316       else
13317 	/* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself.  */
13318 	gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13319       break;
13320 
13321     case LABEL_DECL:
13322       if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13323 	gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13324       break;
13325 
13326     case VAR_DECL:
13327     case RESULT_DECL:
13328       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13329 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13330       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13331 	break;
13332 
13333       /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13334 	 object.  */
13335       gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13336 
13337       /* And its containing type.  */
13338       origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13339       if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13340 	gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13341 
13342       /* And its containing namespace.  */
13343       declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13344 
13345       /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself.  This gets
13346 	 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13347 	 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13348 	 function.  */
13349       origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13350       if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13351 	gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13352       else
13353 	gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13354       break;
13355 
13356     case FIELD_DECL:
13357       /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13358 	 anonymous unions and structs.  */
13359       if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13360 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13361 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13362 	{
13363 	  gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13364 	  gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13365 	}
13366       break;
13367 
13368     case PARM_DECL:
13369       gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13370       gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13371       break;
13372 
13373     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13374       gen_namespace_die (decl);
13375       break;
13376 
13377     default:
13378       /* Probably some frontend-internal decl.  Assume we don't care.  */
13379       gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13380       break;
13381     }
13382 }
13383 
13384 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c after
13385    compilation proper has finished.  */
13386 
13387 static void
dwarf2out_global_decl(tree decl)13388 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13389 {
13390   /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13391      declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13392      corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13393      definitions which have not yet been forced out.  */
13394   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13395     dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13396 }
13397 
13398 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c
13399    and from language front ends (to record built-in types).  */
13400 static void
dwarf2out_type_decl(tree decl,int local)13401 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13402 {
13403   if (!local)
13404     dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13405 }
13406 
13407 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl.  */
13408 
13409 static void
dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl(tree decl,tree context)13410 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13411 {
13412   dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13413   dw_die_ref scope_die;
13414   expanded_location xloc;
13415 
13416   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13417     return;
13418 
13419   gcc_assert (decl);
13420 
13421   /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13422      We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13423      itself.  */
13424 
13425   /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13426      or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die.  */
13427   if (!context)
13428     scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13429   else if (TYPE_P (context))
13430     {
13431       if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13432 	return;
13433     scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13434     }
13435   else
13436     scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13437 
13438   /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE.  */
13439   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13440     {
13441       if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13442 	at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13443       else
13444 	at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13445     }
13446   else
13447     {
13448       at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13449       if (!at_import_die)
13450 	{
13451 	  /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13452 	     emitted the member decl for this field.  Emit it now.  */
13453 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13454 	    {
13455 	      tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13456 	      dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13457 
13458 	      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13459 		if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13460 		  {
13461 		    if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
13462 						   DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13463 		      return;
13464 		  type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13465 		  }
13466 	      else
13467 		type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13468 	      else
13469 		type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13470 	      gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13471 	    }
13472 	  at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13473 	}
13474     }
13475 
13476   /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die.  */
13477   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13478     imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13479   else
13480     imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13481 
13482   xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13483   add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
13484   add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13485   add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13486 }
13487 
13488 /* Write the debugging output for DECL.  */
13489 
13490 void
dwarf2out_decl(tree decl)13491 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13492 {
13493   dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13494 
13495   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13496     {
13497     case ERROR_MARK:
13498       return;
13499 
13500     case FUNCTION_DECL:
13501       /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13502 	 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13503 	 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13504 	 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13505 	 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13506 	 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13507 	 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions.  If
13508 	 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13509 	 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13510 	 with the definition of the function.
13511 
13512 	 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13513 	 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13514 	 declarations.  We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13515 	 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13516 	 function definitions.  These can get inlined within the current
13517 	 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13518 	 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13519 	 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13520 	 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13521 	 that they *are* definitions).
13522 
13523 	 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13524 	 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13525 	 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13526 	 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13527 	 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.  */
13528       if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13529 	return;
13530 
13531       /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13532 	 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  If
13533 	 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE.  */
13534       if (decl_function_context (decl)
13535 	  /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope.  */
13536 	  && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13537 	context_die = NULL;
13538       break;
13539 
13540     case VAR_DECL:
13541       /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13542 	 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13543 	 within this entire compilation unit.  We suppress these DIEs in
13544 	 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13545 	 which are probably useless).  Note that we must not suppress
13546 	 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13547 	 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13548 	 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point.  */
13549       if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13550 	return;
13551 
13552       /* For local statics lookup proper context die.  */
13553       if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13554 	context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13555 
13556       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13557 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13558       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13559 	return;
13560       break;
13561 
13562     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13563       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13564 	return;
13565       if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13566         return;
13567       break;
13568 
13569     case TYPE_DECL:
13570       /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs.  */
13571       if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13572 	return;
13573 
13574       /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13575 	 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling.  */
13576       if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13577 	{
13578 	  /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13579 	     comparisons have.  */
13580 	  if (is_cxx ()
13581 	      && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13582 	      && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13583 	    modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13584 
13585 	  return;
13586 	}
13587 
13588       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types.  */
13589       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13590 	return;
13591 
13592       /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13593 	 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  */
13594       if (decl_function_context (decl))
13595 	context_die = NULL;
13596 
13597       break;
13598 
13599     default:
13600       return;
13601     }
13602 
13603   gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13604 }
13605 
13606 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13607    a lexical block.  */
13608 
13609 static void
dwarf2out_begin_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13610 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13611 		       unsigned int blocknum)
13612 {
13613   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13614   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13615 }
13616 
13617 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13618    lexical block.  */
13619 
13620 static void
dwarf2out_end_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13621 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13622 {
13623   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13624   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13625 }
13626 
13627 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13628    information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13629 
13630    Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13631    as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13632    we may end up calling them anyway.  */
13633 
13634 static bool
dwarf2out_ignore_block(tree block)13635 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13636 {
13637   tree decl;
13638 
13639   for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13640     if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13641 	|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13642       return 0;
13643 
13644   return 1;
13645 }
13646 
13647 /* Hash table routines for file_hash.  */
13648 
13649 static int
file_table_eq(const void * p1_p,const void * p2_p)13650 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
13651 {
13652   const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
13653   const char * p2 = p2_p;
13654   return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
13655 }
13656 
13657 static hashval_t
file_table_hash(const void * p_p)13658 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
13659 {
13660   const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
13661   return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
13662 }
13663 
13664 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13665    dwarf2out.c) and return its "index".  The index of each (known) filename is
13666    just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename.  We
13667    need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13668    section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13669    and.debug_macinfo sections).  If the filename given as an argument is not
13670    found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13671    available unique index number.  In order to speed up searches, we remember
13672    the index of the filename was looked up last.  This handles the majority of
13673    all searches.  */
13674 
13675 static struct dwarf_file_data *
lookup_filename(const char * file_name)13676 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13677 {
13678   void ** slot;
13679   struct dwarf_file_data * created;
13680 
13681   /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13682      call matches this file name.  If so, return the index.  */
13683   if (file_table_last_lookup
13684       && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
13685 	  || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
13686     return file_table_last_lookup;
13687 
13688   /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table.  */
13689   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
13690 				   htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
13691   if (*slot)
13692     return *slot;
13693 
13694   created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
13695   created->filename = file_name;
13696   created->emitted_number = 0;
13697   *slot = created;
13698   return created;
13699 }
13700 
13701 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13702    internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13703    a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet.  The file table
13704    numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13705    types, which may include filenames.  */
13706 
13707 static int
maybe_emit_file(struct dwarf_file_data * fd)13708 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
13709 {
13710   if (! fd->emitted_number)
13711     {
13712       if (last_emitted_file)
13713 	fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
13714       else
13715 	fd->emitted_number = 1;
13716       last_emitted_file = fd;
13717 
13718       if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13719 	{
13720 	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
13721 	  output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, fd->filename);
13722 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13723 	}
13724     }
13725 
13726   return fd->emitted_number;
13727 }
13728 
13729 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location.  We
13730    use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13731    our lookup table.  */
13732 
13733 static void
dwarf2out_var_location(rtx loc_note)13734 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13735 {
13736   char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13737   struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13738   rtx prev_insn;
13739   static rtx last_insn;
13740   static const char *last_label;
13741   tree decl;
13742 
13743   if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13744     return;
13745   prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13746 
13747   newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13748   /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13749      and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13750      last time.  */
13751   if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13752       && last_insn == prev_insn
13753       && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13754       && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13755     {
13756       newloc->label = last_label;
13757     }
13758   else
13759     {
13760       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13761       ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13762       loclabel_num++;
13763       newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13764     }
13765   newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13766   newloc->next = NULL;
13767 
13768   if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13769     newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13770   else
13771     newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13772 
13773   last_insn = loc_note;
13774   last_label = newloc->label;
13775   decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13776   add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13777 }
13778 
13779 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13780    function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13781    declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13782    that hook is called.  Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here.  */
13783 
13784 static void
dwarf2out_begin_function(tree fun)13785 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13786 {
13787   htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13788 
13789   if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13790     have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13791 }
13792 
13793 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13794    and record information relating to this source line, in
13795    'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section.  */
13796 
13797 static void
dwarf2out_source_line(unsigned int line,const char * filename)13798 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13799 {
13800   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13801       && line != 0)
13802     {
13803       int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13804 
13805       switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13806 
13807       /* If requested, emit something human-readable.  */
13808       if (flag_debug_asm)
13809 	fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13810 		 filename, line);
13811 
13812       if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13813 	{
13814 	  /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as.  */
13815 	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13816 
13817 	  /* Indicate that line number info exists.  */
13818 	  line_info_table_in_use++;
13819 	}
13820       else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13821 	{
13822 	  dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13823 	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
13824 					  SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13825 					  separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13826 
13827 	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13828 	  if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13829 	      == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13830 	    {
13831 	      separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13832 	      separate_line_info_table
13833 		= ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13834 			       separate_line_info_table_allocated
13835 			       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13836 	      memset (separate_line_info_table
13837 		       + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13838 		      0,
13839 		      (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13840 		       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13841 	    }
13842 
13843 	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13844 	  line_info
13845 	    = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13846 	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13847 	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13848 	  line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13849 	}
13850       else
13851 	{
13852 	  dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13853 
13854 	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13855 				     line_info_table_in_use);
13856 
13857 	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13858 	  if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13859 	    {
13860 	      line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13861 	      line_info_table
13862 		= ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13863 			       (line_info_table_allocated
13864 				* sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13865 	      memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13866 		      LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13867 	    }
13868 
13869 	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13870 	  line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13871 	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13872 	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13873 	}
13874     }
13875 }
13876 
13877 /* Record the beginning of a new source file.  */
13878 
13879 static void
dwarf2out_start_source_file(unsigned int lineno,const char * filename)13880 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13881 {
13882   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13883     {
13884       /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13885       dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13886 
13887       bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13888       add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13889     }
13890 
13891   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13892     {
13893       int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13894 
13895       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13896       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13897       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13898 				   lineno);
13899 
13900       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
13901     }
13902 }
13903 
13904 /* Record the end of a source file.  */
13905 
13906 static void
dwarf2out_end_source_file(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13907 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13908 {
13909   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13910     /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13911     new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13912 
13913   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13914     {
13915       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13916       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13917     }
13918 }
13919 
13920 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13921    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13922    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13923 
13924 static void
dwarf2out_define(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13925 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13926 		  const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13927 {
13928   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13929     {
13930       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13931       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13932       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13933       dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13934     }
13935 }
13936 
13937 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13938    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13939    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13940 
13941 static void
dwarf2out_undef(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13942 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13943 		 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13944 {
13945   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13946     {
13947       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13948       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13949       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13950       dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13951     }
13952 }
13953 
13954 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation.  */
13955 
13956 static void
dwarf2out_init(const char * filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13957 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13958 {
13959   /* Allocate the file_table.  */
13960   file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
13961 				file_table_eq, NULL);
13962 
13963   /* Allocate the decl_die_table.  */
13964   decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13965 				    decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13966 
13967   /* Allocate the decl_loc_table.  */
13968   decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13969 				    decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13970 
13971   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table.  */
13972   decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13973 
13974   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table.  */
13975   abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13976 					* sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13977   abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13978   /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
13979   abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13980 
13981   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table.  */
13982   line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13983 				       * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13984   line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13985 
13986   /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
13987   line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13988 
13989   /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors.  */
13990   pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13991   pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13992 
13993   /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section.  Note that the (string)
13994      value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13995      will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13996      taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13997      invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled.  We will fill
13998      in this value in dwarf2out_finish.  */
13999   comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
14000 
14001   incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
14002 
14003   used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
14004 
14005   debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
14006 				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14007   debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
14008 				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14009   debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
14010 				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14011   debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
14012 				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14013   debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
14014 				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14015   debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
14016 				   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14017   debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
14018 					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14019 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14020   debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
14021 					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14022 #endif
14023   debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
14024 				   DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
14025   debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
14026 				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14027   debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
14028 				     SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14029 
14030   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14031   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
14032 			       DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14033   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14034   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
14035 			       COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14036   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14037 
14038   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
14039 			       DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14040   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
14041 			       DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14042   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
14043 			       DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14044   switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14045   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
14046   switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
14047   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
14048   switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14049   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
14050 
14051   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14052     {
14053       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14054       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
14055 				   DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14056       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
14057     }
14058 
14059   switch_to_section (text_section);
14060   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
14061   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14062     {
14063       switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14064       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14065     }
14066 }
14067 
14068 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14069    ht_forall.  Emit one queued .debug_str string.  */
14070 
14071 static int
output_indirect_string(void ** h,void * v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14072 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14073 {
14074   struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14075 
14076   if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14077     {
14078       switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14079       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14080       assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14081     }
14082 
14083   return 1;
14084 }
14085 
14086 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14087 /* Verify that all marks are clear.  */
14088 
14089 static void
verify_marks_clear(dw_die_ref die)14090 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14091 {
14092   dw_die_ref c;
14093 
14094   gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14095   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14096 }
14097 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14098 
14099 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14100    Be cool if the mark isn't set.  */
14101 
14102 static void
prune_unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)14103 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14104 {
14105   dw_die_ref c;
14106 
14107   if (die->die_mark)
14108     die->die_mark = 0;
14109   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14110 }
14111 
14112 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14113    it references as attributes and mark them as used.  */
14114 
14115 static void
prune_unused_types_walk_attribs(dw_die_ref die)14116 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14117 {
14118   dw_attr_ref a;
14119   unsigned ix;
14120 
14121   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14122     {
14123       if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14124 	{
14125 	  /* A reference to another DIE.
14126 	     Make sure that it will get emitted.  */
14127 	  prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14128 	}
14129       /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14130 	 accounts properly for it.  */
14131       if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14132 	a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14133     }
14134 }
14135 
14136 
14137 /* Mark DIE as being used.  If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14138    to DIE's children.  */
14139 
14140 static void
prune_unused_types_mark(dw_die_ref die,int dokids)14141 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
14142 {
14143   dw_die_ref c;
14144 
14145   if (die->die_mark == 0)
14146     {
14147       /* We haven't done this node yet.  Mark it as used.  */
14148       die->die_mark = 1;
14149 
14150       /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14151 	 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.)  */
14152       if (die->die_parent)
14153 	prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
14154 
14155       /* Mark any referenced nodes.  */
14156       prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14157 
14158       /* If this node is a specification,
14159          also mark the definition, if it exists.  */
14160       if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
14161         prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
14162     }
14163 
14164   if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
14165     {
14166       /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14167 	 Remember that we've walked the kids.  */
14168       die->die_mark = 2;
14169 
14170       /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14171 	 kids get marked, even if they're types.  */
14172       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
14173 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
14174       else
14175 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14176     }
14177 }
14178 
14179 
14180 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use.  */
14181 
14182 static void
prune_unused_types_walk(dw_die_ref die)14183 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
14184 {
14185   dw_die_ref c;
14186 
14187   /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked.  */
14188   if (die->die_mark)
14189     return;
14190 
14191   switch (die->die_tag) {
14192   case DW_TAG_const_type:
14193   case DW_TAG_packed_type:
14194   case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
14195   case DW_TAG_reference_type:
14196   case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
14197   case DW_TAG_typedef:
14198   case DW_TAG_array_type:
14199   case DW_TAG_structure_type:
14200   case DW_TAG_union_type:
14201   case DW_TAG_class_type:
14202   case DW_TAG_friend:
14203   case DW_TAG_variant_part:
14204   case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
14205   case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
14206   case DW_TAG_string_type:
14207   case DW_TAG_set_type:
14208   case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14209   case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14210   case DW_TAG_file_type:
14211     if (die->die_perennial_p)
14212       break;
14213 
14214     /* It's a type node --- don't mark it.  */
14215     return;
14216 
14217   default:
14218     /* Mark everything else.  */
14219     break;
14220   }
14221 
14222   die->die_mark = 1;
14223 
14224   /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here.  */
14225   prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14226 
14227   /* Mark children.  */
14228   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14229 }
14230 
14231 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14232    attributes.  */
14233 
14234 static void
prune_unused_types_update_strings(dw_die_ref die)14235 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14236 {
14237   dw_attr_ref a;
14238   unsigned ix;
14239 
14240   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14241     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14242       {
14243 	struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14244 	s->refcount++;
14245 	/* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14246 	   twice in the hash table.  */
14247 	if (s->refcount
14248 	    == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14249 	  {
14250 	    void ** slot;
14251 	    slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14252 					     htab_hash_string (s->str),
14253 					     INSERT);
14254 	    gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14255 	    *slot = s;
14256 	  }
14257       }
14258 }
14259 
14260 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked.  */
14261 
14262 static void
prune_unused_types_prune(dw_die_ref die)14263 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14264 {
14265   dw_die_ref c;
14266 
14267   gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14268   prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14269 
14270   if (! die->die_child)
14271     return;
14272 
14273   c = die->die_child;
14274   do {
14275     dw_die_ref prev = c;
14276     for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14277       if (c == die->die_child)
14278 	{
14279 	  /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list.  */
14280 	  if (prev == c)
14281 	    /* No marked children at all.  */
14282 	    die->die_child = NULL;
14283 	  else
14284 	    {
14285 	      prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14286 	      die->die_child = prev;
14287 	    }
14288 	  return;
14289 	}
14290 
14291     if (c != prev->die_sib)
14292       prev->die_sib = c;
14293     prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14294   } while (c != die->die_child);
14295 }
14296 
14297 
14298 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use.  */
14299 
14300 static void
prune_unused_types(void)14301 prune_unused_types (void)
14302 {
14303   unsigned int i;
14304   limbo_die_node *node;
14305   pubname_ref pub;
14306 
14307 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14308   /* All the marks should already be clear.  */
14309   verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14310   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14311     verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14312 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14313 
14314   /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used.  */
14315   prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14316   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14317     prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14318 
14319   /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14320      pubname_table or arange_table.  */
14321   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
14322     prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
14323   for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14324     prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14325 
14326   /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts.  */
14327   if (debug_str_hash)
14328     htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14329   prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14330   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14331     prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14332 
14333   /* Leave the marks clear.  */
14334   prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14335   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14336     prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14337 }
14338 
14339 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14340    the file table.  */
14341 static int
file_table_relative_p(void ** slot,void * param)14342 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
14343 {
14344   bool *p = param;
14345   struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
14346   if (d->emitted_number && d->filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14347     {
14348       *p = true;
14349       return 0;
14350     }
14351   return 1;
14352 }
14353 
14354 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14355    and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info.  */
14356 
14357 static void
dwarf2out_finish(const char * filename)14358 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14359 {
14360   limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14361   dw_die_ref die = 0;
14362 
14363   /* Add the name for the main input file now.  We delayed this from
14364      dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.  */
14365   add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14366   if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14367     add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14368   else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14369     {
14370       bool p = false;
14371       htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
14372       if (p)
14373 	add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14374     }
14375 
14376   /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links.  The only
14377      dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14378      inline functions, and the comp_unit_die.  We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14379      For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14380      instance.  */
14381   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14382     {
14383       next_node = node->next;
14384       die = node->die;
14385 
14386       if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14387 	{
14388 	  dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14389 
14390 	  if (origin)
14391 	    add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14392 	  else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14393 	    ;
14394 	  else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14395 	    /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input.  */
14396 	    add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14397 	  else
14398 	    {
14399 	      /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14400 		 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14401 		 in the nested function die being orphaned.  Likewise
14402 		 with the return type of that nested function.  Force
14403 		 this to be a child of the containing function.
14404 
14405 		 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14406 		 inlined and optimized out.  In that case we are lost and
14407 		 assign the empty child.  This should not be big issue as
14408 		 the function is likely unreachable too.  */
14409 	      tree context = NULL_TREE;
14410 
14411 	      gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14412 
14413 	      if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14414 		context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14415 	      else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14416 		context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14417 
14418 	      gcc_assert (context
14419 			  && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
14420 			      || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
14421 
14422 	      origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14423 	      if (origin)
14424 	        add_child_die (origin, die);
14425 	      else
14426 	        add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14427 	    }
14428 	}
14429     }
14430 
14431   limbo_die_list = NULL;
14432 
14433   /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14434      emit full debugging info for them.  */
14435   retry_incomplete_types ();
14436 
14437   if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14438     prune_unused_types ();
14439 
14440   /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14441      They will go into limbo_die_list.  */
14442   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14443     break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14444 
14445   /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14446      that have children.  */
14447   add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14448   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14449     add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14450 
14451   /* Output a terminator label for the .text section.  */
14452   switch_to_section (text_section);
14453   targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14454   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14455     {
14456       switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14457       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14458     }
14459 
14460   /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14461      in .text.  */
14462   if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14463     {
14464       add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14465       add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14466     }
14467 
14468   /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14469      "base address".  Use zero so that these addresses become absolute.  */
14470   else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14471     add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14472 
14473   /* Output location list section if necessary.  */
14474   if (have_location_lists)
14475     {
14476       /* Output the location lists info.  */
14477       switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14478       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14479 				   DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14480       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14481       output_location_lists (die);
14482     }
14483 
14484   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14485     add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14486 		    debug_line_section_label);
14487 
14488   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14489     add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14490 
14491   /* Output all of the compilation units.  We put the main one last so that
14492      the offsets are available to output_pubnames.  */
14493   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14494     output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14495 
14496   output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14497 
14498   /* Output the abbreviation table.  */
14499   switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14500   output_abbrev_section ();
14501 
14502   /* Output public names table if necessary.  */
14503   if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
14504     {
14505       switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14506       output_pubnames (pubname_table);
14507     }
14508 
14509 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14510   /* Output public types table if necessary.  */
14511   if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
14512     {
14513       switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
14514       output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
14515     }
14516 #endif
14517 
14518   /* Output the address range information.  We only put functions in the arange
14519      table, so don't write it out if we don't have any.  */
14520   if (fde_table_in_use)
14521     {
14522       switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14523       output_aranges ();
14524     }
14525 
14526   /* Output ranges section if necessary.  */
14527   if (ranges_table_in_use)
14528     {
14529       switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14530       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14531       output_ranges ();
14532     }
14533 
14534   /* Output the source line correspondence table.  We must do this
14535      even if there is no line information.  Otherwise, on an empty
14536      translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14537      .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14538      examining the file.  This is done late so that any filenames
14539      used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'.  */
14540   if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14541     {
14542       switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14543       output_line_info ();
14544     }
14545 
14546   /* Have to end the macro section.  */
14547   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14548     {
14549       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14550       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14551     }
14552 
14553   /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14554      table too.  */
14555   if (debug_str_hash)
14556     htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14557 }
14558 #else
14559 
14560 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons.  */
14561 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14562 
14563 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14564 
14565 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
14566